Symbol Technologies Ds 3408 Users Manual

DS 3408 to the manual 181a3b72-7353-40e9-b866-b8e4fd12c950

2015-02-02

: Symbol-Technologies Symbol-Technologies-Ds-3408-Users-Manual-449040 symbol-technologies-ds-3408-users-manual-449040 symbol-technologies pdf

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 396

DownloadSymbol-Technologies Symbol-Technologies-Ds-3408-Users-Manual-  Symbol-technologies-ds-3408-users-manual
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
DS 3408
Product Reference Guide

DS 3408
Product Reference Guide

72-68456-01
Revision A
July 2004

© 2004 by Symbol Technologies, Inc. All rights reserved.
No part of this publication may be reproduced or used in any form, or by any electrical or mechanical means, without permission in writing from
Symbol. This includes electronic or mechanical means, such as photocopying, recording, or information storage and retrieval systems. The material
in this manual is subject to change without notice.
The software is provided strictly on an “as is” basis. All software, including firmware, furnished to the user is on a licensed basis. Symbol grants
to the user a non-transferable and non-exclusive license to use each software or firmware program delivered hereunder (licensed program). Except
as noted below, such license may not be assigned, sublicensed, or otherwise transferred by the user without prior written consent of Symbol. No
right to copy a licensed program in whole or in part is granted, except as permitted under copyright law. The user shall not modify, merge, or
incorporate any form or portion of a licensed program with other program material, create a derivative work from a licensed program, or use a
licensed program in a network without written permission from Symbol. The user agrees to maintain Symbol’s copyright notice on the licensed
programs delivered hereunder and to include the same on any authorized copies it makes, in whole or in part. The user agrees not to decompile,
disassemble, decode, or reverse engineer any licensed program delivered to the user or any portion thereof.
Symbol reserves the right to make changes to any software or product to improve reliability, function, or design.
Symbol does not assume any product liability arising out of, or in connection with, the application or use of any product, circuit, or application
described herein.
No license is granted, either expressly or by implication, estoppel, or otherwise under any Symbol Technologies, Inc., intellectual property rights.
An implied license only exists for equipment, circuits and subsystems contained in Symbol products.
Symbol, Spectrum One and Spectrum24 are registered trademarks of Symbol Technologies, Inc. Other product names mentioned in this manual
may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective companies and are hereby acknowledged.
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300
http://www.symbol.com

Contents
About This Guide
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Chapter Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Notational Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Related Publications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Service Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Symbol Support Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv

Chapter 1. Getting Started
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Unpacking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Setting Up the Digital Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Installing the Interface Cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Removing the Interface Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Connecting a Synapse Cable Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Connecting Power (if required) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Configuring the Digital Scanner. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6

Chapter 2. Scanning
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Beeper Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
LED Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Scanning in Hand-Held Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Scanning with the Digital Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6

iv DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7
Scanning in Hands-Free Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Decode Zones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Near Focus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Far Focus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Toggled Focus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11

Chapter 3. Maintenance and Technical Specifications
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Technical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5
Digital Scanner Signal Descriptions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6

Chapter 4. User Preferences
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3
User Preferences Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4
User Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5
Set Default Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5
Parameter Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5
Beeper Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6
Beeper Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7
Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7
Time Delay to Low Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8
Trigger Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9
Decode Session Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10
Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10
Beep After Good Decode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11
Scanstand Session Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11

Chapter 5. Decoding Preferences
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
Decoding Preferences Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
Decoding Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5
Focus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5
Decoding Illumination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6
Decode Aiming Pattern. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6

Chapter 6. Keyboard Wedge Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Connecting a Keyboard Wedge Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3
Keyboard Wedge Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4
Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5

Contents

Keyboard Wedge Host Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5
Keyboard Wedge Country Types (Country Codes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6
Ignore Unknown Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8
Keystroke Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8
Intra-Keystroke Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-9
Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-9
Caps Lock On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Caps Lock Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Convert Wedge Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-11
Function Key Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-11
FN1 Substitution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12
Send Make and Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12
Keyboard Maps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-13
ASCII Character Set for Keyboard Wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15

Chapter 7. RS-232 Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Connecting an RS-232 Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-4
RS-232 Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5
RS-232 Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-6
RS-232 Host Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-8
Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-9
Parity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-11
Stop Bit Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-12
Data Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-12
Check Receive Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-13
Hardware Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-14
Hardware Handshaking (continued) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-15
Software Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-16
Host Serial Response Time-out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-17
RTS Line State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-18
Beep on  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-18
Intercharacter Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-19
Nixdorf Beep/LED Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-20
Ignore Unknown Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-20
ASCII Character Set for RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21

Chapter 8. USB Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
Connecting a USB Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3
USB Parameter Defaults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4
USB Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
USB Device Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
USB Country Keyboard Types (Country Codes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
USB Keystroke Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
USB CAPS Lock Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
USB Ignore Unknown Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9

v

vi DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Emulate Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
USB Keyboard FN 1 Substitution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Function Key Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Simulated Caps Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Convert Case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
ASCII Character Set for USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12

Chapter 9. IBM 468X/469X Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Connecting to an IBM 468X/469X Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3
IBM Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-4
IBM 468X/469X Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5
Port Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5
Convert Unknown to Code 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6

Chapter 10. Wand Emulation Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Connecting Using Wand Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3
Wand Emulation Parameter Defaults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-4
Wand Emulation Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-5
Wand Emulation Host Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-5
Leading Margin (Quiet Zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Ignore Unknown Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-8
Convert Code 39 to Full ASCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9

Chapter 11. Scanner Emulation Interface
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Connecting Using Scanner Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-3
Scanner Emulation Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-4
Scanner Emulation Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-6
Scanner Emulation Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-6
Beep Style. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-6
Parameter Pass-Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-7
Convert Newer Code Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-7
Module Width. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-8
Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-8
Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-9
Transmission Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-9
Ignore Unknown Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-10
Leading Margin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-11
Check For Decode LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-12

Chapter 12. 123 Scan
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
Communication with 123Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-3

Contents

123Scan Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-3

Chapter 13. Symbologies
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-5
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-5
Symbology Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-6
UPC/EAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-E1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-11
Enable/Disable EAN-8/JAN-8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-11
Enable/Disable EAN-13/JAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-12
Enable/Disable Bookland EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-12
Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-13
UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-14
Transmit UPC-A Check Digit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-15
Transmit UPC-E Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-15
Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-16
UPC-A Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-16
UPC-E Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-17
UPC-E1 Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-18
Convert UPC-E to UPC-A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-18
Convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-19
EAN-8/JAN-8 Extend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-19
UCC Coupon Extended Code. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-20
Code 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-20
Enable/Disable Code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-20
Enable/Disable UCC/EAN-128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21
Enable/Disable ISBT 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21
Code 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-22
Enable/Disable Trioptic Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-22
Convert Code 39 to Code 32. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-23
Code 32 Prefix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-23
Set Lengths for Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-24
Code 39 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-25
Transmit Code 39 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
Code 39 Buffering (Scan & Store) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-27
Code 93. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-29
Enable/Disable Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-29
Set Lengths for Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-30
Code 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-31
Code 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-31
Set Lengths for Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-32
Code 11 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-33
Transmit Code 11 Check Digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34

vii

viii DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34
Enable/Disable Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34
Set Lengths for Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-35
I 2 of 5 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-36
Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-37
Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-37
Discrete 2 of 5 (DTF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Enable/Disable Discrete 2 of 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Set Lengths for Discrete 2 of 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Codabar (NW - 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-39
Enable/Disable Codabar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-39
Set Lengths for Codabar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-40
CLSI Editing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
NOTIS Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
Enable/Disable MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
Set Lengths for MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
MSI Check Digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-43
Transmit MSI Check Digit(s). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-44
MSI Check Digit Algorithm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-44
Postal Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
US Postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
US Planet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
UK Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-46
Transmit UK Postal Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-46
Japan Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-47
Australian Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-47
Dutch Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-48
Transmit US Postal Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-48
RSS (Reduced Space Symbology). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS-14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS Limited . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS Expanded. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-50
Convert RSS to UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-50
Composite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite CC-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite CC-A/B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite TLC-39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-52
UPC Composite Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-53
Composite Beep Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-54
UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for UCC/EAN Composite Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-54
2D Symbologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Enable/Disable PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Enable/Disable MicroPDF417. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Code 128 Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-56
Data Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
QR Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-58

Contents

Redundancy Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-59
Security Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-61
Intercharacter Gap Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-62
Report Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-62
Macro PDF Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63
Flush Macro Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63
Abort Macro PDF Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63

Chapter 14. Miscellaneous Scanner Options
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-3
Miscellaneous Scanner Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-4
Miscellaneous Scanner Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5
Transmit Code ID Character . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5
Prefix/Suffix Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-6
Scan Data Transmission Format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-7
FN1 Substitution Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-8
Transmit “No Read” Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-9
Synapse Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-10

Chapter 15. Advanced Data Formatting
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
Rules: Criteria Linked to Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-3
Using ADF Bar Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-4
ADF Bar Code Menu Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-4
Rule 1: The Code 128 Scanning Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
Rule 2: The UPC Scanning Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
Alternate Rule Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
Rules Hierarchy (in Bar Codes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-6
Default Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
Special Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
Pause Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
Begin New Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
Save Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-9
Quit Entering Rules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-9
Disable Rule Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-10
Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-11
Code Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-11
Code Lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-17
Message Containing A Specific Data String . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-22
Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-27
Send Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-27
Setup Field(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
Modify Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-36
Pad Data with Spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-37

ix

x DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Pad Data with Zeros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-41
Beeps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
Send Keystroke (Control Characters and Keyboard Characters) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
Send Right Control Key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-82
Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-83
Turn On/Off Rule Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-88
Alphanumeric Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-90

Appendix A. Standard Default Parameters
Appendix B. Programming Reference
Symbol Code Identifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
AIM Code Identifiers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-4

Appendix C. Sample Bar Codes
Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UPC/EAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UPC-A, 100 % . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EAN-13, 100 % . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RSS 14. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
QR Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
US Postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UK Postal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

C-3
C-3
C-3
C-3
C-3
C-4
C-4
C-4
C-4
C-5
C-5
C-5
C-5

Appendix D. Numeric Bar Codes
Numeric Bar Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3
Cancel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4

Appendix E. ASCII Character Sets
Glossary
Index

About This Guide
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Chapter Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Notational Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Related Publications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Service Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Symbol Support Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv

xii DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

xiii

Introduction
The DS 3408 Product Reference Guide provides general instructions for setting up, operating, maintaining, and troubleshooting the
DS 3408 Standard Range and DS 3408 High Density digital scanners.

Chapter Descriptions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•

Chapter 1, Getting Started provides a product overview, unpacking instructions, and cable connection information.
Chapter 2, Scanning describes parts of the digital scanner, beeper and LED definitions, and how to use the digital scanner
in hand-held and hands-free modes.
Chapter 3, Maintenance and Technical Specifications provides information on how to care for the digital scanner,
troubleshooting, and technical specifications.
Chapter 4, User Preferences provides programming bar codes for selecting user preference features for the digital scanner.
Chapter 5, Decoding Preferences provides programming bar codes for selecting digital scanner preference features.
Chapter 6, Keyboard Wedge Interface describes how to set up a Keyboard Wedge interface with the digital scanner.
Chapter 7, RS-232 Interface describes how to set up the digital scanner with an RS-232 host, such as point-of-sale devices,
host computers, or other devices with an available RS-232 port.
Chapter 8, USB Interface describes how to set up the digital scanner with a USB host.
Chapter 9, IBM 468X/469X Interface describes how to set up the digital scanner with IBM 468X/469X POS systems.
Chapter 10, Wand Emulation Interface describes how to set up the digital scanner with a Wand Emulation host when Wand
Emulation communication is needed.
Chapter 11, Scanner Emulation Interface describes how to set up the digital scanner with an Undecoded Scanner Emulation
host.
Chapter 12, 123 Scan describes the 123Scan PC-based scanner configuration tool, and provides the bar code to scan to
communicate with the 123Scan program.
Chapter 13, Symbologies describes all symbology features and provides the programming bar codes necessary for selecting
these features for the digital scanner.
Chapter 14, Miscellaneous Scanner Options includes commonly used bar codes to customize how data is transmitted to the
host device.
Chapter 15, Advanced Data Formatting (ADF) describes how to customize scanned data before transmitting to the host.
Chapter A, Standard Default Parameters provides a table of all host devices and miscellaneous digital scanner defaults.
Chapter B, Programming Reference provides a table of AIM code identifiers, ASCII character conversions, and keyboard
maps.
Chapter C, Sample Bar Codes includes sample bar codes.
Chapter D, Numeric Bar Codes includes the numeric bar codes to scan for parameters requiring specific numeric values.
Chapter E, ASCII Character Sets provides ASCII character value tables.

Notational Conventions
The following conventions are used in this document:
•

•

Bullets (•) indicate:
• action items
• lists of alternatives
• lists of required steps that are not necessarily sequential.
Sequential lists (e.g., those that describe step-by-step procedures) appear as numbered lists.

xiv DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

•

Throughout the programming bar code menus, asterisks (*) are used to denote default parameter settings.

* Indicates Default

*Baud Rate 9600

Feature/Option

Related Publications
The LS/DS 3408 Quick Start Guide, p/n 72-67131-xx, provides general information for getting started with the digital scanner, and
includes basic set up and operation instructions.
For the latest versions of the Quick Start Guide and Product Reference Guide go to: http://www.symbol.com/manuals.

Service Information
If you have a problem with your equipment, contact the Symbol Support Center for your region. See page xvi for contact information.
Before calling, have the model number, serial number, and several of your bar code symbols at hand.
Call the Support Center from a phone near the scanning equipment so that the service person can try to talk you through your problem.
If the equipment is found to be working properly and the problem is symbol readability, the Support Center will request samples of
your bar codes for analysis at our plant.
If your problem cannot be solved over the phone, you may need to return your equipment for servicing. If that is necessary, you will
be given specific directions.

Note

Symbol Technologies is not responsible for any damages incurred during shipment if the approved shipping
container is not used. Shipping the units improperly can possibly void the warranty. If the original shipping
container was not kept, contact Symbol to have another sent to you.

Symbol Support Center
For service information, warranty information, or technical assistance contact or call the Symbol Support Center in:
United States
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300
1-800-653-5350

Canada
Symbol Technologies Canada, Inc.
2540 Matheson Boulevard East
Mississauga, Ontario, Canada L4W 4Z2
905-629-7226

United Kingdom
Symbol Technologies
Symbol Place
Winnersh Triangle, Berkshire RG41 5TP
United Kingdom
0800 328 2424 (Inside UK)
+44 118 945 7529 (Outside UK)

Asia/Pacific
Symbol Technologies Asia, Inc (Singapore Branch)
230 Victoria Street #05-07/09
Bugis Junction Office Tower
Singapore 188024
Tel : +65-6796-9600
Fax : +65-6337-6488

xv

Australia
Symbol Technologies Pty. Ltd.
432 St. Kilda Road
Melbourne, Victoria 3004
1-800-672-906 (Inside Australia)
+61-3-9866-6044 (Outside Australia)

Austria/Österreich
Symbol Technologies Austria GmbH
Prinz-Eugen Strasse 70 / 2.Haus
1040 Vienna, Austria
01-5055794-0 (Inside Austria)
+43-1-5055794-0 (Outside Austria)

Denmark/Danmark
Symbol Technologies AS
Dr. Neergaardsvej 3
2970 Hørsholm
7020-1718 (Inside Denmark)
+45-7020-1718 (Outside Denmark)

Europe/Mid-East Distributor Operations
Contact your local distributor or call
+44 118 945 7360

Finland/Suomi
Oy Symbol Technologies
Kaupintie 8 A 6
FIN-00440 Helsinki, Finland
9 5407 580 (Inside Finland)
+358 9 5407 580 (Outside Finland)

France
Symbol Technologies France
Centre d'Affaire d'Antony
3 Rue de la Renaissance
92184 Antony Cedex, France
01-40-96-52-21 (Inside France)
+33-1-40-96-52-50 (Outside France)

Germany/Deutschland
Symbol Technologies GmbH
Waldstrasse 66
D-63128 Dietzenbach, Germany
6074-49020 (Inside Germany)
+49-6074-49020 (Outside Germany)

Italy/Italia
Symbol Technologies Italia S.R.L.
Via Cristoforo Columbo, 49
20090 Trezzano S/N Navigilo
Milano, Italy
2-484441 (Inside Italy)
+39-02-484441 (Outside Italy)

Latin America Sales Support
2730 University Dr.
Coral Springs, FL 33065 USA
1-800-347-0178 (Inside United States)
+1-954-255-2610 (Outside United States)
954-340-9454 (Fax)

Mexico/México
Symbol Technologies Mexico Ltd.
Torre Picasso
Boulevard Manuel Avila Camacho No 88
Lomas de Chapultepec CP 11000
Mexico City, DF, Mexico
5-520-1835 (Inside Mexico)
+52-5-520-1835 (Outside Mexico)
Norway/Norge
Symbol’s registered and mailing address:
Symbol Technologies Norway
Hoybratenveien 35 C
N-1055 OSLO, Norway

Netherlands/Nederland
Symbol Technologies
Kerkplein 2, 7051 CX
Postbus 24 7050 AA
Varsseveld, Netherlands
315-271700 (Inside Netherlands)
+31-315-271700 (Outside Netherlands)

Symbol’s repair depot and shipping address:
Symbol Technologies Norway
Enebakkveien 123
N-0680 OSLO, Norway
+47 2232 4375

xvi DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

South Africa
Symbol Technologies Africa Inc.
Block B2
Rutherford Estate
1 Scott Street
Waverly 2090 Johannesburg
Republic of South Africa
11-809 5311 (Inside South Africa)
+27-11-809 5311 (Outside South Africa)

Spain/España
Symbol Technologies S.L.
Avenida de Bruselas, 22
Edificio Sauce
Alcobendas, Madrid 28108
Spain
91 324 40 00 (Inside Spain)
+34 91 324 40 00 (Outside Spain)
Fax: +34.91.324.4010

Sweden/Sverige
“Letter” address:
Symbol Technologies AB
Box 1354
S-171 26 SOLNA
Sweden
Visit/shipping address:
Symbol Technologies AB
Solna Strandväg 78
S-171 54 SOLNA
Sweden
Switchboard: 08 445 29 00 (domestic)
Call Center: +46 8 445 29 29 (international)
Support E-Mail: Sweden.Support@se.symbol.com

If you purchased your Symbol product from a Symbol Business Partner, contact that Business Partner for service.

Getting Started
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Unpacking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Setting Up the Digital Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Installing the Interface Cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Removing the Interface Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Connecting a Synapse Cable Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Connecting Power (if required) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Configuring the Digital Scanner. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6

1-2

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Getting Started

1-3

Introduction
The digital scanner combines superior 1D and 2D omnidirectional bar code scanning and advanced ergonomics to provide the best
value in a digital scanner. Whether in hand-held mode or hands-free mode in a stand, the digital scanner ensures comfort and ease
of use for extended periods of time.

Figure 1-1. DS 3408 Digital Scanner
The digital scanner supports:
•

•
•

•
•
•
•
•

Keyboard Wedge connection to a host. The host interprets scanned data as keystrokes. This interface supports the following
international keyboards (for Windows® environment): North America, German, French, French Canadian, Spanish, Italian,
Swedish, UK English, Portuguese-Brazilian, and Japanese.
Standard RS-232 connection to a host. Scan bar code menus to set up proper communication of the digital scanner with the
host.
USB connection to a host. The digital scanner autodetects a USB host and defaults to the HID keyboard interface type. Select
other USB interface types by scanning programming bar code menus.This interface supports the following international
keyboards (for Windows® environment): North America, German, French, French Canadian, Spanish, Italian, Swedish, UK
English, Portuguese-Brazilian, and Japanese.
Connection to IBM® 468X/469X hosts. Scan bar code menus to set up communication of the digital scanner with the IBM
terminal.
Wand Emulation connection to a host. The digital scanner is connected to a portable data terminal, a controller, or host which
collects the data as wand data and decodes it.
Scanner Emulation connection to a host. The digital scanner is connected to a portable data terminal, a controller which
collects the data and interprets it for the host.
Synapse capability which allows connection to a wide variety of host systems using a Synapse and Synapse adapter cable.
The digital scanner autodetects the host.
Configuration via 123Scan.

1-4

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Unpacking
Remove the digital scanner from its packing and inspect it for damage. If the digital scanner was damaged in transit, call the Symbol
Support Center at one of the telephone numbers listed on page xiv. KEEP THE PACKING. It is the approved shipping container; use
this to return the equipment for servicing.

Setting Up the Digital Scanner
Installing the Interface Cable
1. Loosen the two screws on the cable clamp at the bottom of the digital scanner and gently pull the clamp away from the
bottom of the digital scanner.

Figure 1-2. Loosening Screws on Bottom of Digital Scanner
2. Open the clamp and plug the interface cable modular connector into the cable interface port on the bottom of the digital
scanner handle.

Figure 1-3. Connecting the Interface Cable
3. Gently tug the cable to ensure the connector is properly secured.

Getting Started

1-5

4. Close the clamp, push it back into place and tighten the screws on the clamp to secure the cable into the bottom of the digital
scanner.

Figure 1-4. Securing the Clamp
5. Connect the other end of the interface cable to the host (see the specific host chapter for information on host connections).
Different cables are required for different hosts. The connectors illustrated in each host chapter are examples
only. The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the digital scanner
remain the same.

Removing the Interface Cable
1. Loosen the two screws on the cable clamp at the bottom of the digital scanner and gently pull the clamp away from the
bottom of the digital scanner.
2. Open the clamp and unplug the interface cable modular connector from the cable interface port on the bottom of the digital
scanner handle. Carefully slide out the cable.
3. Follow the steps for Installing the Interface Cable on page 1-4 to connect a new cable.

1-6

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Connecting a Synapse Cable Interface
Refer to the Synapse Interface Guide provided with the Synapse cable for detailed setup instructions.

Note
Symbol’s Synapse Smart Cables enable interfacing to a variety of hosts. The Synapse cable has built-in intelligence to detect that
host.
To host

Synapse Adapter Cable
Synapse Smart Cable
To digital scanner

Figure 1-5. Synapse Cable Connection
1. Plug the Synapse adapter cable (p/n 25-32463-xx) into the bottom of the digital scanner, as described in Installing the
Interface Cable on page 1-4.
2. Align the ‘S’ on the Synapse adapter cable with the ‘S’ on the Synapse Smart Cable and plug the cable in.
3. Connect the other end of the Synapse Smart Cable to the host.

Connecting Power (if required)
If the host does not provide power to the digital scanner, connect an external power supply to the digital scanner:
1. Connect the interface cable to the bottom of the digital scanner, as described in Installing the Interface Cable on page 1-4.
2. Connect the other end of the interface cable to the host (refer to the host manual to locate the correct port).
3. Plug the power supply into the power jack on the interface cable. Plug the other end of the power supply into an AC outlet.

Configuring the Digital Scanner
To configure the digital scanner, use the bar codes included in this manual, or the 123Scan configuration program.
See Chapter 4, User Preferences for information about programming the digital scanner using bar code menus. Also see each hostspecific chapter to set up connection to a specific host type.
See Chapter 12, 123 Scan to configure the digital scanner using this configuration program. A help file is available in the program.

Scanning
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Beeper Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
LED Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Scanning in Hand-Held Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Scanning with the Digital Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Scanning in Hands-Free Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Decode Zones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Near Focus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Far Focus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Toggled Focus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11

2-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanning 2-3

Introduction
This chapter provides beeper and LED definitions, techniques involved in scanning bar codes, general instructions and tips about
scanning, and decode zone diagrams.

Scan Window
Tether Plate

LED
Indicators
Scan Trigger

Figure 2-1. Parts

2-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Beeper Definitions
The digital scanner issues different beep sequences and patterns to indicate status. Table 2-1 defines beep sequences that occur
during both normal scanning and while programming the digital scanner.

Table 2-1. Beeper Definitions
Beeper Sequence

Indication

Standard Use
Short low/short medium/short high beep Power up.
sequence
1 short high beep

A bar code symbol was decoded (if decode beeper is enabled).

4 long low beeps

A transmission error was detected in a scanned symbol. The data is ignored. This occurs if the digital scanner is not
properly configured. Check option setting.

5 low beeps

Conversion or format error.

Lo/hi/lo beeps

ADF transmit error. See Chapter 15, Advanced Data Formatting.

Short high/short high/short high/long low RS-232 receive error.
beep sequence
Parameter Menu Scanning
Short high beep

Correct entry scanned or correct menu sequence performed.

Long low/long high beep sequence

Input error; incorrect bar code, programming sequence, or Cancel scanned; digital scanner remains in ADF program
mode.

Short high/short low beep sequence

Keyboard parameter selected. Enter value using numeric bar codes.

Short high/short low/short high/short
low beep sequence

Successful program exit with change in parameter setting.

Short low/short high/short low/short
high beep sequence

Out of host parameter storage space. Scan Set Default Parameter on page 4-5.

Code 39 Buffering
Hi/lo beeps

New Code 39 data was entered into the buffer.

3 long high beeps

Code 39 buffer is full.

Lo/hi/lo beeps

The Code 39 buffer was erased or there was an attempt to clear or transmit an empty buffer.

Lo/hi beeps

A successful transmission of buffered data.

Macro PDF
2 long low beeps

File ID error. A bar code not in the current MPDF sequence was scanned.

3 long low beeps

Out of memory. There is not enough buffer space to store the current MPDF symbol.

4 long low beeps

Bad symbology. Scanned a 1D or 2D bar code in a MPDF sequence, a duplicate MPDF label, a label in an incorrect order,
or trying to transmit an empty or illegal MPDF field.

5 long low beeps

Flushing MPDF buffer.

Fast warble beep

Aborting MPDF sequence.

Lo/Hi beeps

Flushing an already empty MPDF buffer.

ADF Programming: Normal Data Entry. Duration of tones are short.
Hi/Lo beeps

Enter another digit. Add leading zeros to the front if necessary.

Lo/Lo beeps

Enter another alphabetic character or scan the End of Message bar code.

Scanning 2-5

Table 2-1. Beeper Definitions (Continued)
Beeper Sequence

Indication

Hi/Hi beeps

Enter another criterion or action, or scan the Save Rule bar code.

Hi/Lo/Hi/Lo beeps

Rule saved. Rule entry mode exited.

Hi/Lo/Lo beeps

All criteria or actions cleared for current rule, continue entering rule.

Low beep

Delete last saved rule. The current rule is left intact.

Lo/Hi/Hi beeps

All rules are deleted.

ADF Programming: Error Indications. Duration of tones are very long.
Lo/Hi/Lo/Hi beeps

Out of rule memory. Erase some existing rules, then try to save rule again. (It is not necessary to re-enter the current
rule.)

Lo/Hi/Lo beeps

Cancel rule entry. Rule entry mode exited because of an error or the user asked to exit rule entry.

Lo/Hi beeps

Entry error, wrong bar code scanned. Re-enter criterion or action. All previously entered criteria and actions are
retained. Criteria or action list is too long for a rule.

Host Specific
USB only
4 short high beeps

Digital scanner has not completed initialization. Wait several seconds and scan again.

Short low/short medium/short high
beep sequence after scanning a USB
device type

Communication with the bus must be established before the digital scanner can operate at the highest power level.

Short low/short medium/short high
The USB bus can put the digital scanner in a state where power to the digital scanner is cycled on and off more than
beep sequence occurs more than once once. This is normal and usually happens when the PC cold boots.
RS-232 only
1 short high beep

A  character is received and Beep on  is enabled.

LED Definitions
In addition to beep sequences, the digital scanner uses a two-color LED to indicate status. Table 2-2 defines LED colors that display
during scanning.

Table 2-2. Standard LED Definitions
LED

Indication

Off

No power is applied to the digital scanner, or the digital scanner is on and ready to scan.

Green

A bar code was successfully decoded.

Red

A data transmission error or digital scanner malfunction occurred.

2-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanning in Hand-Held Mode
Install and program the digital scanner (see Setting Up the Digital Scanner on page 1-4). For assistance, contact the local supplier or
the local Symbol Support Center.

Scanning with the Digital Scanner
1. Ensure all connections are secure (see the appropriate host chapter.)
2. Aim the digital scanner at the bar code.
3. Press and hold the trigger.

Figure 2-2. Scanning in Hand-Held Mode
4. The digital scanner projects a red laser aiming pattern (shown below) which allows positioning the bar code or object within
the field of view.

Figure 2-3. Laser Aiming Pattern
If necessary, the digital scanner turns on its red LEDs to illuminate the target bar code.
5. Center the symbol in any orientation within the aiming pattern. Be sure the entire symbol is within the rectangular area
formed by the brackets in the pattern.
2D barsymbol
code
PDF417

1D bar
Linear
barcode
code
Symbol

Aiming Pattern

Figure 2-4. Centering Symbol in Aiming Pattern

Scanning 2-7

6. Hold the trigger until the digital scanner beeps, indicating the bar code is successfully decoded. For more information on
beeper and LED definitions, see Table 2-1 and Table 2-2.
This process usually occurs instantaneously. Steps 2 - 4 are repeated on poor quality or difficult bar codes, until the bar code is
decoded, the trigger is released, or the Decode Session Timeout is reached.

Aiming
Hold the digital scanner between two and nine inches (depending on symbol density; see Decode Zones on page 2-9) from the symbol,
centering the aiming pattern cross hairs on the symbol.
The aiming pattern is smaller when the digital scanner is closer to the symbol and larger when it is farther from the symbol. Scan
symbols with smaller bars or elements (mil size) closer to the digital scanner, and those with larger bars or elements (mil size) farther
from the digital scanner.
The digital scanner can also read a bar code presented within the aiming pattern but not centered. The top examples in Figure 2-5
show acceptable aiming options, while the bottom examples can not be decoded.

012345

012345

012345

012345

Figure 2-5. Acceptable and Incorrect Aiming

2-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanning in Hands-Free Mode
The optional Intellistand adds greater flexibility to scanning operation. When the digital scanner is seated in the stand’s “cup,” the
digital scanner’s built-in sensor places the digital scanner in hands-free mode. When the digital scanner is removed from the stand
it operates in its normal hand-held mode.

Adjust angle of
scanner “cup”
Scanner “Cup”

Adjust height of
IntelliStand

Figure 2-6. Inserting the Digital Scanner in the Intellistand
To operate the digital scanner in the IntelliStand:
1. Ensure the digital scanner is properly connected to the host (see the appropriate host chapter for information on host
connections).
2. Insert the digital scanner in the Intellistand by placing the front of the digital scanner into the stand’s “cup” (see Figure 2-6).
3. Use the Intellistand’s adjustment knobs to adjust the height and angle of the digital scanner.
4. Center the symbol in the aiming pattern. The entire symbol must be within the brackets.
5. Upon successful decode, the digital scanner beeps and the LED turns green. For more information on beeper and LED
definitions, see Table 2-1 and Table 2-2.

Scanning 2-9

Decode Zones
Near Focus
Note: Typical performance at 73˚F (23˚C)
on high quality symbols in normal room light.
Vcc = 3.3V

Top of
scanner

in.

cm

3.5

8.9

1.75 4.4

0

1.75 4.4

5 mil

2.0

5.5

6.67 mil PDF417

2.3

3.5 8.9
6.3

10 mil PDF417

1.8

5.8

13 mil (100% UPC)

0.8
*

4.5

7.5 mil

1.3

15 mil PDF417

7.3
6.0

20 mil

9.5

*

In.
cm

0
0

2
5.1

0

4
10.2

6
15.2

8
20.3

10
25.4

Depth of Field
* Minimum distance determined by symbol length and scan angle.

Figure 2-7. DS 3408 Near Focus Decode Zone

W
i
d
t
h
o
f
F
i
e
l
d

2-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Far Focus
Note: Typical performance at 73˚F (23˚C)
on high quality symbols in normal room light.
Vcc = 3.3V

Top of
scanner

5 mil
5.0
6.0
7.5 mil

2.8

4.3
1.5

8.5

10 mil PDF417
8.8
13 mil (100% UPC)

15 mil PDF417

*

14.5
12.3

20 mil

20.0

*

In.
cm

0
0

5
12.7

10
25.4

15
38.1

20
50.8

Depth of Field
* Minimum distance determined by symbol length and scan angle.

Figure 2-8. DS 3408 Far Focus Decode Zone

in.

cm

8

20.3

4

10.2

0

0

4

10.2

8

20.3

W
i
d
t
h
o
f
F
i
e
l
d

Scanning 2-11

Toggled Focus
Note: Typical performance at 73˚F (23˚C)
on high quality symbols in normal room light.
Vcc = 3.3V

Top of
scanner

2.0

5 mil

in.

cm

8

20.3

4

10.2

0

0

4

10.2

8

20.3

6.0

6.67 mil PDF417

2.3
1.3
1.8
0.8
*

4.5

7.5 mil

8.5

10 mil PDF417
8.8
13 mil (100% UPC)
15 mil PDF417

14.5
12.3

20 mil

20.0

*

In.
cm

0
0

5
12.7

10
25.4

15
38.1

20
50.8

Depth of Field
* Minimum distance determined by symbol length and scan angle.

Figure 2-9. DS 3408 Toggled Focus Decode Zone

W
i
d
t
h
o
f
F
i
e
l
d

2-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Maintenance and Technical
Specifications
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Digital Scanner Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6

3-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Maintenance and Technical Specifications 3-3

Introduction
This chapter provides suggested scanner maintenance, troubleshooting, technical specifications, and signal descriptions (pinouts).

Maintenance
Cleaning the scan window is the only maintenance required. A dirty window can affect scanning accuracy.
•
•
•
•

Do not allow abrasive material to touch the window.
Remove any dirt particles with a damp cloth.
Wipe the window using a tissue moistened with ammonia/water.
Do not spray water or other cleaning liquids directly into the window.

Troubleshooting
Table 3-1. Troubleshooting
Problem
The aiming pattern does not appear when pressing
the trigger.

Possible Causes

Possible Solutions

No power to the digital scanner.

If the configuration requires a power supply,
re-connect the power supply.

Incorrect host interface cable is used.

Connect the correct host interface cable.

Interface/power cables are loose.

Re-connect cables.

Digital scanner is disabled.

For Synapse or IBM 468x mode, enable the digital
scanner via the host interface. Otherwise, see the
technical person in charge of scanning.

If using RS-232 Nixdorf B mode, CTS is not asserted. Assert CTS line.
Aiming pattern is disabled.

Enable the aiming pattern. See Decode Aiming
Pattern on page 5-6.

Scanner emits short low/short medium/short high The USB bus may put the digital scanner in a state Normal during host reset.
beep sequence (power-up beep sequence) more than where power to the digital scanner is cycled on and
once.
off more than once.
Digital scanner emits aiming pattern, but does not
decode the bar code.

Digital scanner is not programmed for the correct bar Program the digital scanner to read that type of bar
code type.
code. See Chapter 13, Symbologies.
Bar code symbol is unreadable.

Scan test symbols of the same bar code type to
determine if the bar code is defaced.

The symbol is not completely inside aiming pattern. Move the symbol completely within the aiming
pattern.
Digital scanner emits 4 short high beeps during
decode attempt.

Digital scanner has not completed USB initialization. Wait several seconds and scan again.

3-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 3-1. Troubleshooting (Continued)
Problem
Digital scanner decodes bar code, but does not
transmit the data to the host.

Possible Causes

Possible Solutions

Digital scanner is not programmed for the correct
host type.

Scan the appropriate host type programming bar
code. See the chapter corresponding to the host
type.

Interface cable is loose.

Re-connect the cable.

If 4 long low beeps are heard, a transmission error
occurred.

Set the digital scanner's communication parameters
to match the host's setting.

If 5 low beeps are heard, a conversion or format error Configure the digital scanner's conversion
occurred.
parameters properly.

Host displays scanned data incorrectly.

If lo/hi/lo beeps are heard, an invalid ADF rule is
detected.

Program the correct ADF rules.

If hi/lo beeps are heard, the digital scanner is
buffering Code 39 data.

Normal scanning a Code 39 bar code and the Code
39 Buffering option is enabled.

Digital scanner is not programmed to work with the Scan the appropriate host type programming bar
host.
code.
For RS-232, set the digital scanner's communication
parameters to match the host's settings.
For a Keyboard Wedge configuration, program the
system for the correct keyboard type, and turn off the
CAPS LOCK key.
Program the proper editing options (e.g., UPC-E to
UPC-A Conversion).

Digital scanner emits hi/hi/hi/Lo beeps when not in RS-232 receive error.
use.

Normal during host reset. Otherwise, set the digital
scanner's RS-232 parity to match the host setting.

Digital scanner emits lo/hi beeps during
programming.

Input error or Cancel bar code was scanned.

Scan the correct numeric bar codes within range for
the parameter programmed.

Digital scanner emits lo/hi/lo/hi beeps during
programming.

Out of ADF parameter storage space.

Erase all rules and re-program with shorter rules.

Out of Synapse parameter storage space.

Scan Set Synapse Defaults bar code for cables no
longer in use and re-program the digital scanner for
the current host interface.

Digital scanner emits lo/hi/lo beeps.

Clearing Code 39 buffer.

Normal when scanning the Code 39 Buffering Clear
Buffer bar code or upon attempt to transmit an
empty Code 39 buffer.

Digital scanner emits a power-up beep after
changing USB host type.

The USB bus re-established power to the digital
scanner.

Normal when changing USB host type.

Digital scanner emits one high beep when not in use. In RS-232 mode, a  character was received
and Beep on  option is enabled.

Normal when Beep on  is enabled and the
digital scanner is in RS-232 mode.

If after performing these checks the digital scanner still experiences problems, contact the distributor or call
the local Symbol Support Center. See page xiv for the telephone numbers.

Note

Maintenance and Technical Specifications 3-5

Technical Specifications
Table 3-2. Technical Specifications
Item

Description

Power Requirements

5 VDC + / - 10% @ approximately 220 mA RMS (nominal), 500 mA (max)

Power Source

Depending on host:
• Host powered
• External power supply, 5.2 V nominal

Decode Capability

UPC/EAN, UPC/EAN with supplementals, UCC/EAN, JAN 8 & 13, 128, Code 39, Code 39 Full ASCII, Code 39 Trioptic,
Codabar (NW7), Interleaved 2 of 5, Discrete 2 of 5, IATA 2 of 5, Code 128, Code 93, MSI, Code 11, Code 32, Coupon
Code, Bookland EAN, RSS, US Postnet, US Planet,UK Postal, Japan Postal, Australia Postal, Dutch Postal, Composite
Codes, PDF417, MicroPDF, Maxicode, Data Matrix (ECC 200), QR Code.

Beeper Operation

User-selectable: enable, disable

Beeper Volume

User-selectable: three levels

Beeper Tone

User-selectable: three tones

Yaw Tolerance

± 50° from normal

Pitch Tolerance

± 60° from normal

Roll Tolerance

± 180° from normal

Print Contrast Minimum

25% minimum reflectance differential, measured at 650 nm.

Ambient Light Immunity

10,000 Ft Candles (107,600 Lux)

Durability

6.5 ft (2 m) drop to concrete

Operating Temperature

-4° to 122° F (-20° to 50° C)

Storage Temperature

-40° to 158° F (-40° to 70° C)

Humidity

5% to 95% (non-condensing)

Weight (without cable)

11.73 oz. (335 g)

Dimensions:
Height
Width
Depth

7.34 in. (18.65 cm)
4.82 in. (12.25 cm)
2.93 in. (7.43 cm)

Laser

650nm laser diode

Laser Classifications

IEC 825-1 Class 2

ESD

15 kV area discharge
8 kV contact discharge

Minimum Element Width

5 mil (0.127 mm)

Interfaces Supported

RS-232, Keyboard Wedge, Wand Emulation, Scanner Emulation, IBM 468X/469X, USB, Synapse

Electrical Safety

UL1950, CSA C22.2 No.950. EN60950/IC950

Input Transient Protection

IEC 1000-4-(2,3,4,5,6,11)

EMI

FCC Part 15 Class B, ICES-003 Class B European Union EMC Directive,
Japan VCCI/MITI/Dentori

3-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Digital Scanner Signal Descriptions

Bottom of scanner

Cable interface port

PIN 10

PIN 1

Interface cable
modular connector

Figure 3-1. Digital Scanner Cable Pinouts
The signal descriptions in Table 3-3 apply to the connector on the digital scanner and are for reference only.

Table 3-3. Digital Scanner Signal Pin-outs
Pin

IBM

Synapse

RS-232

Keyboard Wedge

Wand

Scanner
Emulation

USB

1

Reserved

SynClock

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Jump to Pin 6

DBP

2

Power

Power

Power

Power

Power

Power

Power

3

Ground

Ground

Ground

Ground

Ground

Ground

Ground

4

IBM_A(+)

Reserved

TxD

KeyClock

DBP

Reserved

SOS

5

Reserved

Reserved

RxD

TermData

CTS

D+

Decode

6

IBM_B(-)

SynData

RTS

KeyData

RTS

Jump to Pin 1

Trigger

7

Reserved

Reserved

CTS

TermClock

Reserved

D-

Enable

8

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

9

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

10

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

User Preferences
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
User Preferences Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
User Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Set Default Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Parameter Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Beeper Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6
Beeper Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7
Time Delay to Low Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
Trigger Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9
Decode Session Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
Beep After Good Decode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Scanstand Session Timeout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11

4-2

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

User Preferences 4-3

Introduction
If desired, program the digital scanner to perform various functions, or activate different features. This chapter describes each user
preference feature and provides the programming bar codes necessary for selecting these features.
The digital scanner ships with the settings shown in the Table 4-1 on page 4-4 (also see Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters
for all host device and miscellaneous defaults). If the default values suit requirements, programming is not necessary.
To set feature values, scan a single bar code or a short bar code sequence. The settings are stored in non-volatile memory and are
preserved even when the digital scanner is powered down.

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the
screen, be sure to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and
bars and/or spaces are not merging.

If not using a Synapse or USB cable, select a host type (see each host chapter for specific host information) after the
power-up beeps sound. This is only necessary upon the first power-up when connected to a new host.
To return all features to default values, scan the Set All Defaults bar code on 4-5. Throughout the programming bar code menus,
default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

*High Volume

Feature/Option

Scanning Sequence Examples
In most cases, scanning one bar code sets the parameter value. For example, to set the beeper tone to high, scan the High Frequency
(beeper tone) bar code listed under Beeper Tone on page 4-6. The digital scanner issues a fast warble beep and the LED turns green,
signifying a successful parameter entry.
Other parameters, such as Serial Response Time-Out or Data Transmission Formats, require scanning several bar codes. See
these parameter descriptions for this procedure.

Errors While Scanning
Unless otherwise specified, to correct an error during a scanning sequence, just re-scan the correct parameter.

4-4

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

User Preferences Parameter Defaults
Table 4-1 lists defaults for user preferences parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the User
Preferences section beginning on page 4-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 4-1. User Preferences Default Table
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

User Preferences
Set Default Parameter

All Defaults

4-5

Parameter Scanning

ECh

Enable

4-5

Beeper Tone

91h

Medium

4-6

Beeper Volume

8Ch

High

4-7

Power Mode

80h

Continuous On

4-7

Time Delay to Low Power Mode

92h

5 Minutes

4-8

Trigger Mode

8Ah

Level

4-9

Decode Session Timeout

88h

9.9 Sec

4-10

Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol

89h

0.6 Sec

4-10

Beep After Good Decode

38h

Enable

4-11

Scanstand Session Timeout

F0h, 90h

2 Seconds

4-11

User Preferences 4-5

User Preferences
Set Default Parameter
Scan this bar code to return all parameters to the default values listed in Table A-1 on page A-3.

*Set All Defaults

Parameter Scanning
Parameter # ECh
To disable decoding of parameter bar codes, scan the Disable Parameter Scanning bar code below. Note that the Set Defaults
parameter bar code can still be decoded. To enable decoding of parameter bar codes, either scan Enable Parameter Scanning or
Set All Defaults.

*Enable Parameter Scanning
(01h)

Disable Parameter Scanning
(00h)

4-6

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Beeper Tone
Parameter # 91h
To select a decode beep frequency (tone), scan the Low Frequency, Medium Frequency, or High Frequency bar code.

Low Frequency
(02h)

*Medium Frequency
(Optimum Setting)
(01h)

High Frequency
(00h)

User Preferences 4-7

Beeper Volume
Parameter # 8Ch
To select a beeper volume, scan the Low Volume, Medium Volume, or High Volume bar code.

Low Volume
(02h)

Medium Volume
(01h)

*High Volume
(00h)

Power Mode
Parameter # 80h
This parameter determines whether or not power remains on after a decode attempt. In reduced power mode, the digital scanner
enters into a low power consumption mode to preserve battery life after each decode attempt. In continuous power mode, power
remains on after each decode attempt.

*Continuous On
(00h)

Reduced Power Mode
(01h)

4-8

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Time Delay to Low Power Mode
Parameter # 92h
This parameter only applies when Power Mode is set to Reduced Power.

Note

This parameter sets the time the digital scanner remains active after decoding. The digital scanner wakes upon trigger pull or when
the host attempts to communicate with the digital scanner.

1 Second
(11h)

5 Seconds
(15h)

1 Minute
(21h)

*5 Minutes
(25h)

User Preferences 4-9

Time Delay to Low Power Mode (continued)

15 Minutes
(2Bh)

1 Hour
(31h)

Trigger Mode
Parameter # 8Ah
Select one of the following trigger modes for the digital scanner:
•
•

•

Level - A trigger pull activates decode processing. Decode processing continues until the bar code is decoded, the trigger
is released, or the Decode Session Timeout is reached.
Blink - This trigger mode is used in hands-free (Intellistand) mode. The digital scanner activates decode processing when
it detects a bar code in its field of view. Decoding range is reduced in this mode.
Host - A host command issues the triggering signal. The digital scanner interprets an actual trigger pull as a Level triggering
option.

*Level
(00h)

Blink
(07h)

Host
(08h)

4-10

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Decode Session Timeout
Parameter # 88h
This parameter sets the maximum time decode processing continues during a scan attempt. It is programmable in 0.1 second
increments from 0.5 to 9.9 seconds. The default timeout is 9.9 seconds.
To set a Decode Session Timeout, scan the bar code below. Next, scan two numeric bar codes from Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes
that correspond to the desired on time. Single digit numbers must have a leading zero. For example, to set a Decode Session Timeout
of 0.5 seconds, scan the bar code below, then scan the 0 and 5 bar codes. To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel
on page D-4.

Decode Session Timeout

Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol
Parameter # 89h
This option is used in hands-free (Intellistand) mode to prevent the beeper from continuously beeping when a symbol is left in the
digital scanner’s field of view. It is programmable in 0.1 second increments from 0.0 to 9.9 seconds. The default interval is 0.6 seconds.
To select the timeout between decodes for the same symbol, scan the bar code below, then scan two numeric bar codes from
Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes that correspond to the desired interval, in 0.1 second increments.

Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol

User Preferences 4-11

Beep After Good Decode
Parameter # 38h
Scan a bar code below to select whether or not the digital scanner beeps after a good decode. If selecting Do Not Beep After Good
Decode, the beeper still operates during parameter menu scanning and to indicate error conditions.

*Beep After Good Decode
(Enable)
(01h)

Do Not Beep After Good Decode
(Disable)
(00h)

Scanstand Session Timeout
Parameter # F0h, 90h
To set the amount of time the digital scanner attempts to decode a bar code in hands-free mode (blink mode), scan the bar code below.
Next, scan three numeric bar codes from Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes to select a value between 1 and 255 that represents tenths
of a second. Single digit numbers must have a leading zero. For example, to set 0.5 seconds, scan the bar code below, then scan the
0, 0, 5 bar codes. To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4. The default value is 2 seconds.

Scanstand Session Timeout

4-12

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Decoding Preferences
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Decoding Preferences Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Decoding Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Focus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Decoding Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Decode Aiming Pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6

5-2

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Decoding Preferences 5-3

Introduction
If desired, program the digital scanner to perform various functions, or activate different features. This chapter describes digital
scanner preference features and provides the programming bar codes for selecting these features.
The digital scanner ships with the settings shown in the Decoding Preferences Default Table on page 5-4 (also see Appendix A,
Standard Default Parameters for all host device and miscellaneous defaults). If the default values suit requirements, programming is
not necessary.
To set feature values, scan a single bar code or a short bar code sequence. The settings are stored in non-volatile memory and are
preserved even when the digital scanner is powered down.

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the
screen, be sure to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and
bars and/or spaces are not merging.

If not using a Synapse or USB cable, select a host type (see each host chapter for specific host information) after the power-up beeps
sound. This is only necessary upon the first power-up when connected to a new host.
To return all features to default values, scan the Set Default Parameter bar code on page 4-5. Throughout the programming bar code
menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

Feature/Option

* Indicates Default

*Enable Decode Aiming Pattern
(02h)

Hex Value

Scanning Sequence Examples
In most cases scanning one bar code sets the parameter value. For example, to disable the decode aiming pattern, scan the Disable
Decode Aiming Pattern bar code listed under Decode Aiming Pattern on page 5-6. The digital scanner issues a fast warble beep
and the LED turns green, signifying a successful parameter entry.
Other parameters require scanning several bar codes. See these parameter descriptions for this procedure.

Errors While Scanning
Unless otherwise specified, to correct an error during a scanning sequence, just re-scan the correct parameter.

Decoding Preferences Parameter Defaults
Table 5-1 lists defaults for digital scanner preferences parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided
in Decoding Preferences on page 5-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note

5-4

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 5-1. Decoding Preferences Default Table
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Decoding Options
Focus Mode

F0h A6h

Far Focus

5-5

Decoding Illumination

F0h 2Ah

Enable

5-6

Decode Aiming Pattern

F0h 32h

Enable

5-6

Decoding Preferences 5-5

Decoding Preferences
The parameters in this chapter control bar code decoding characteristics.

Focus Mode
Parameter # F0h, A6h
Select the Focus Mode to control the working range of the digital scanner. If Far Focus is selected, the digital scanner is optimized
to read at its far position. With Near Focus, the digital scanner is optimized to read at its near position. Smart Focus toggles the
focus position after every frame.

*Far Focus
(00h)

Near Focus
(01h)

Smart Focus
(02h)

5-6

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Decoding Illumination
Parameter # F0h, 2Ah
Selecting Enable Illumination causes the digital scanner to flash illumination to aid decoding. Select Disable Illumination to prevent
the digital scanner from using decoding illumination.
Enabling illumination usually results in superior images. The effectiveness of the illumination decreases as the distance to the target
increases.

*Enable Decoding Illumination
(01h)

Disable Decoding Illumination
(00h)

Decode Aiming Pattern
Parameter # F0h, 32h
This parameter only applies when in Decode Mode. Select Enable Decode Aiming Pattern to project the aiming pattern during bar
code capture, or Disable Decode Aiming Pattern to turn the aiming pattern off.

*Enable Decode Aiming Pattern
(02h)

Disable Decode Aiming Pattern
(00h)

Keyboard Wedge Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Connecting a Keyboard Wedge Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Keyboard Wedge Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
Keyboard Wedge Host Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
Keyboard Wedge Country Types (Country Codes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Ignore Unknown Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Keystroke Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Intra-Keystroke Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Caps Lock On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Caps Lock Override. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Convert Wedge Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Function Key Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
FN1 Substitution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Send Make and Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Keyboard Maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
ASCII Character Set for Keyboard Wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15

6-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up a Keyboard Wedge interface with the digital scanner. With this interface, the digital scanner is
connected between the keyboard and host computer, and translates bar code data into keystrokes. The host computer accepts the
keystrokes as if they originated from the keyboard. This mode adds bar code reading functionality to a system designed for manual
keyboard input. Keyboard keystrokes are simply passed through.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

Note

*North American

Feature/Option

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

Connecting a Keyboard Wedge Interface
Male DIN Connector

Keyboard Connector

Female DIN Connector

Figure 6-1. Keyboard Wedge Connection with Y-cable
To connect the Keyboard Wedge interface Y-cable:

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 6-1 are examples only.
The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain the
same.

1. Turn off the host and unplug the keyboard connector.
2. Attach the modular connector of the Y-cable to the cable interface port on the digital scanner. (See Installing the Interface
Cable on page 1-4.)

6-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.

Connect the round male DIN host connector of the Y-cable to the keyboard port on the host device.
Connect the round female DIN keyboard connector of the Y-cable to the keyboard connector.
If needed, attach the optional power supply to the connector in the middle of the Y-cable.
Ensure that all connections are secure.
Turn on the host system.
Select the Keyboard Wedge host type by scanning the appropriate bar code from Keyboard Wedge Host Types on page 6-5.
To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.

Keyboard Wedge Parameter Defaults
Table 6-1 lists the defaults for Keyboard Wedge host parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) in the
Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters section beginning on page 6-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 6-1. Keyboard Wedge Host Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters
Keyboard Wedge Host Type

IBM PC/AT& IBM PC Compatibles

6-5

Country Types (Country Codes)

North American

6-6

Ignore Unknown Characters

Transmit

6-8

Keystroke Delay

No Delay

6-8

Intra-Keystroke Delay

Disable

6-9

Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation

Disable

6-9

Caps Lock On

Disable

6-10

Caps Lock Override

Disable

6-10

Convert Wedge Data

No Convert

6-11

Function Key Mapping

Disable

6-11

FN1 Substitution

Disable

6-12

Send and Make Break

Send

6-12

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-5

Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters
Keyboard Wedge Host Types
Select the Keyboard Wedge host by scanning one of the bar codes below.

IBM PC/AT & IBM PC Compatibles

IBM PS/2 (Model 30)

IBM AT Notebook

IBM XT

NCR 7052

6-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Wedge Country Types (Country Codes)
Scan the bar code corresponding to the keyboard type. If the keyboard type is not listed, see Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation on
page 6-9.

*North American

German Windows

French Windows

French Canadian Windows 95/98

French Canadian Windows XP/2000

Spanish Windows

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-7

Keyboard Wedge Country Types (continued)

Italian Windows

Swedish Windows

UK English Windows

Japanese Windows

Portuguese-Brazilian Windows

6-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Ignore Unknown Characters
Unknown characters are characters the host does not recognize. When Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters is selected,
all bar code data is sent except for unknown characters, and no error beeps sound on the digital scanner. When Do Not Send Bar
Codes With Unknown Characters is selected, bar code data is sent up to the first unknown character, then the digital scanner
issues an error beep.

*Send Bar Codes with Unknown Characters
(Transmit)

Do Not Send Bar Codes with Unknown Characters

Keystroke Delay
This is the delay in milliseconds between emulated keystrokes. Scan a bar code below to increase the delay when hosts require a
slower transmission of data.

*No Delay

Medium Delay (20 msec)

Long Delay (40 msec)

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-9

Intra-Keystroke Delay
When enabled, an additional delay is inserted between each emulated key depression and release. This sets the Keystroke Delay
parameter to a minimum of 5 msec as well.

Enable

*Disable
Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation
This allows emulation of most other country keyboard types not listed in Keyboard Wedge Country Types (Country Codes) on page 66 in a Microsoft® operating system environment.

Enable Alternate Numeric Keypad

*Disable Alternate Numeric Keypad

6-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Caps Lock On
When enabled, the digital scanner emulates keystrokes as if the Caps Lock key is always pressed.

Enable Caps Lock On

*Disable Caps Lock On
Caps Lock Override
When enabled, on AT or AT Notebook hosts, the keyboard ignores the state of the Caps Lock key. Therefore, an ‘A’ in the bar code is
sent as an ‘A’ no matter what the state of the keyboard’s Caps Lock key.

Enable Caps Lock Override

*Disable Caps Lock Override
If both Caps Lock On and Caps Lock Override are enabled, Caps Lock Override takes precedence.

Note

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-11

Convert Wedge Data
When enabled, the digital scanner converts all bar code data to the selected case.

Convert to Upper Case

Convert to Lower Case

*No Convert
Function Key Mapping
ASCII values under 32 are normally sent as control key sequences (see Table 6-2 on page 6-15). When this parameter is enabled, the
keys in bold are sent in place of the standard key mapping. Table entries that do not have a bold entry remain the same whether or
not this parameter is enabled.

Enable

*Disable

6-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

FN1 Substitution
When this is enabled, the digital scanner replaces FN1 characters in an EAN128 bar code with a keystroke chosen by the user (see
FN1 Substitution Values on page 14-8).

Enable

*Disable
Send Make and Break
When enabled, the scan codes for releasing a key are not sent.

*Send Make and Break Scan Codes

Send Make Scan Code Only

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-13

Keyboard Maps
The following keyboard maps are provided for prefix/suffix keystroke parameters. To program the prefix/suffix values, see the bar
codes on page 14-6.

7014

5001

5002

5003

5004

5005

5006

5007

5008

5009

5010

5011

5012

7008

7009

7010

7007

7006
7001

7011

7012

7003

7002

7004

7005

7013

7015

7017

7016

7018

Figure 6-2. IBM PS2 Type Keyboard

5001

5002

5003

5004

7008

7014

7009

7012

7003

7004

7006

7013
5005

5006

5007

5008

5009

5010

7011

7002

Figure 6-3. IBM PC/XT

5001

5002

5003

5004

7008

7009

7014

7012

7003

7013
5005

5006

5007

5008

5009

5010

7004

7011

Figure 6-4. IBM PC/AT

7002

6-14 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

5001

5002

1045

5013

5003

5004

5014

5015

5005

5006

1043

5016

5007

5008

5017

5018

5009

5010

7013

5019

5011

5012

1048

1046

(7013 if double key)

(1048 if double key)

Figure 6-5. NCR 7052 32-KEY

1065

1066

1067

1068

1072

1073

1074

1079

1080

1081

5001

5002

5011

5003

1069

1070

1071

1075

1076

1077

1078

1082

1083

1084

1085

1045

5013

1086

5004

5014

5015

1087

5005

5006

1043

5016

1088

5007

5008

5017

5018

1089

5009

5010

7013

5019

1090

1048

5012

(1048 if double key)

1046

(1043 if double key)

Figure 6-6. NCR 7052 58-KEY

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-15

ASCII Character Set for Keyboard Wedge
Note

Code 39 Full ASCII interprets the bar code special character ($ + % /) preceding a Code 39 character and
assigns an ASCII character value to the pair. For example, when Code 39 Full ASCII is enabled and +B is
scanned, it is interpreted as b, %J as ?, and %V as @. Scanning ABC%I outputs the keystroke equivalent
of ABC >.

Table 6-2. Keyboard Wedge ASCII Character Set
Full ASCII
Code 39
Encode Char.acter

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1001

$A

CTRL A

1002

$B

CTRL B

1003

$C

CTRL C

1004

$D

CTRL D

1005

$E

CTRL E

1006

$F

CTRL F

1007

$G

CTRL G

1008

$H

CTRL H/BACKSPACE1

1009

$I

CTRL I/HORIZONTAL
TAB1

1010

$J

CTRL J

1011

$K

CTRL K

1012

$L

CTRL L

1013

$M

CTRL M/ENTER1

1014

$N

CTRL N

1015

$O

CTRL O

1016

$P

CTRL P

1017

$Q

CTRL Q

1018

$R

CTRL R

1019

$S

CTRL S

1020

$T

CTRL T

1021

$U

CTRL U

1022

$V

CTRL V

1023

$W

CTRL W

1024

$X

CTRL X

1025

$Y

CTRL Y

1026

$Z

CTRL Z

1027

%A

CTRL [ /ESC1

1

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,
the unbolded keystroke is sent.

6-16 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 6-2. Keyboard Wedge ASCII Character Set (Continued)
Full ASCII
Code 39
Encode Char.acter

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1028

%B

CTRL \

1029

%C

CTRL ]

1030

%D

CTRL 6

1031

%E

CTRL -

1032

Space

Space

1033

/A

!

1034

/B

“

1035

/C

#

1036

/D

$

1037

/E

%

1038

/F

&

1039

/G

‘

1040

/H

(

1041

/I

)

1042

/J

*

1043

/K

+

1044

/L

,

1045

-

-

1046

.

.

1047

/O

/

1048

0

0

1049

1

1

1050

2

2

1051

3

3

1052

4

4

1053

5

5

1054

6

6

1055

7

7

1056

8

8

1057

9

9

1058

/Z

:

1059

%F

;

1060

%G

<

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-17

Table 6-2. Keyboard Wedge ASCII Character Set (Continued)
Full ASCII
Code 39
Encode Char.acter

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1061

%H

=

1062

%I

>

1063

%J

?

1064

%V

@

1065

A

A

1066

B

B

1067

C

C

1068

D

D

1069

E

E

1070

F

F

1071

G

G

1072

H

H

1073

I

I

1074

J

J

1075

K

K

1076

L

L

1077

M

M

1078

N

N

1079

O

O

1080

P

P

1081

Q

Q

1082

R

R

1083

S

S

1084

T

T

1085

U

U

1086

V

V

1087

W

W

1088

X

X

1089

Y

Y

1090

Z

Z

1091

%K

[

1092

%L

\

1093

%M

]

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

6-18 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 6-2. Keyboard Wedge ASCII Character Set (Continued)
Full ASCII
Code 39
Encode Char.acter

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1094

%N

^

1095

%O

_

1096

%W

‘

1097

+A

a

1098

+B

b

1099

+C

c

1100

+D

d

1101

+E

e

1102

+F

f

1103

+G

g

1104

+H

h

1105

+I

i

1106

+J

j

1107

+K

k

1108

+L

l

1109

+M

m

1110

+N

n

1111

+O

o

1112

+P

p

1113

+Q

q

1114

+R

r

1115

+S

s

1116

+T

t

1117

+U

u

1118

+V

v

1119

+W

w

1120

+X

x

1121

+Y

y

1122

+Z

z

1123

%P

{

1124

%Q

|

1125

%R

}

1126

%S

~

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-19

Table 6-3. Keyboard Wedge ALT Key Character Set
ALT Keys

Keystroke

2065

ALT A

2066

ALT B

2067

ALT C

2068

ALT D

2069

ALT E

2070

ALT F

2071

ALT G

2072

ALT H

2073

ALT I

2074

ALT J

2075

ALT K

2076

ALT L

2077

ALT M

2078

ALT N

2079

ALT O

2080

ALT P

2081

ALT Q

2082

ALT R

2083

ALT S

2084

ALT T

2085

ALT U

2086

ALT V

2087

ALT W

2088

ALT X

2089

ALT Y

2090

ALT Z

Table 6-4. Keyboard Wedge GUI Key Character Set
GUI Keys

Keystrokes

3000

Right Control Key

3048

GUI 0

3049

GUI 1

3050

GUI 2

3051

GUI 3

3052

GUI 4

6-20 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 6-4. Keyboard Wedge GUI Key Character Set (Continued)
GUI Keys

Keystrokes

3053

GUI 5

3054

GUI 6

3055

GUI 7

3056

GUI 8

3057

GUI 9

3065

GUI A

3066

GUI B

3067

GUI C

3068

GUI D

3069

GUI E

3070

GUI F

3071

GUI G

3072

GUI H

3073

GUI I

3074

GUI J

3075

GUI K

3076

GUI L

3077

GUI M

3078

GUI N

3079

GUI O

3080

GUI P

3081

GUI Q

3082

GUI R

3083

GUI S

3084

GUI T

3085

GUI U

3086

GUI V

3087

GUI W

3088

GUI X

3089

GUI Y

3090

GUI Z

Keyboard Wedge Interface 6-21

Table 6-5. Keyboard Wedge F Key Character Set
F Keys

Keystroke

5001

F1

5002

F2

5003

F3

5004

F4

5005

F5

5006

F6

5007

F7

5008

F8

5009

F9

5010

F10

5011

F11

5012

F12

5013

F13

5014

F14

5015

F15

5016

F16

5017

F17

5018

F18

5019

F19

5020

F20

5021

F21

5022

F22

5023

F23

5024

F24

Table 6-6. Keyboard Wedge Numeric Keypad Character Set
Numeric Keypad

Keystroke

6042

*

6043

+

6044

undefined

6045

-

6046

.

6047

/

6048

0

6049

1

6-22 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 6-6. Keyboard Wedge Numeric Keypad Character Set (Continued)
Numeric Keypad

Keystroke

6050

2

6051

3

6052

4

6053

5

6054

6

6055

7

6056

8

6057

9

6058

Enter

6059

Num Lock

Table 6-7. Keyboard Wedge Extended Keypad Character Set
Extended Keypad

Keystroke

7001

Break

7002

Delete

7003

Pg Up

7004

End

7005

Pg Dn

7006

Pause

7007

Scroll Lock

7008

Backspace

7009

Tab

7010

Print Screen

7011

Insert

7012

Home

7013

Enter

7014

Escape

7015

Up Arrow

7016

Dn Arrow

7017

Left Arrow

7018

Right Arrow

RS-232 Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Connecting an RS-232 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-4
RS-232 Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
RS-232 Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
RS-232 Host Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
Parity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Stop Bit Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Data Bits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Check Receive Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
Hardware Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14
Hardware Handshaking (continued). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
Software Handshaking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16
Host Serial Response Time-out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17
RTS Line State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
Beep on  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
Intercharacter Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
Nixdorf Beep/LED Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-20
Ignore Unknown Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
ASCII Character Set for RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21

7-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

RS-232 Interface 7-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up the digital scanner with an RS-232 host. The RS-232 interface is used to connect the digital
scanner to point-of-sale devices, host computers, or other devices with an available RS-232 port (e.g., com port).
If the host is not listed in Table 7-2, refer to the documentation for the host device to set communication parameters to match the host.

Note

The digital scanner uses TTL RS-232 signal levels, which interface with most system architectures. For
system architectures requiring RS-232C signal levels, Symbol offers different cables providing TTL-to-RS232C conversion. Contact the Symbol Support Center for more information.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

Note

*Baud Rate 9600

Feature/Option

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

7-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Connecting an RS-232 Interface
This connection is made directly from the digital scanner to the host computer.

Interface Cable
Serial Port Connector to Host

Power Supply Cable

Figure 7-1. RS-232 Direct Connection

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 7-1 are examples only.
The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain the
same.

1. Attach the modular connector of the RS-232 interface cable to the cable interface port on the digital scanner (see Installing
the Interface Cable on page 1-4).
2. Connect the other end of the RS-232 interface cable to the serial port on the host.
3. Connect the power supply to the serial connector end of the RS-232 interface cable. Plug the power supply into an
appropriate outlet.
4. Select the RS-232 host type by scanning the appropriate bar code from RS-232 Host Types on page 7-8.
5. To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.

RS-232 Interface 7-5

RS-232 Parameter Defaults
Table 7-1 lists the defaults for RS-232 host parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the RS232 Host Parameters section beginning on page 7-6.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 7-1. RS-232 Host Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

RS-232 Host Parameters
RS-232 Host Types

Standard

7-8

Baud Rate

9600

7-10

Parity Type

None

7-11

Stop Bit Select

1 Stop Bit

7-12

Data Bits

8-Bit

7-12

Check Receive Errors

Enable

7-13

Hardware Handshaking

None

7-15

Software Handshaking

None

7-16

Host Serial Response Time-out

2 Sec

7-17

RTS Line State

Low RTS

7-18

Beep on 

Disable

7-18

Intercharacter Delay

0 msec

7-19

Nixdorf Beep/LED Options

Normal Operation

7-20

Ignore Unknown Characters

Send Bar Code

7-20

7-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

RS-232 Host Parameters
Various RS-232 hosts are set up with their own parameter default settings (Table 7-2). Selecting standard, ICL, Fujitsu, Wincor-Nixdorf
Mode A, Wincor-Nixdorf Mode B, OPOS/JPOS, Olivetti, or Omron sets the defaults listed below.

Table 7-2. Terminal Specific RS-232
Parameter
Transmit Code ID

Standard
(Default)

ICL

Fujitsu

WincorNixdorf
Mode A

Wincor-Nixdorf
Mode B/OPOS/
JPOS

Olivetti

Omron

No

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Data as is

Data/Suffix

Data/Suffix

Data/Suffix

Data/Suffix

Prefix/Data/
Suffix

Data/Suffix

Suffix

CR/LF (7013)

CR (1013)

CR (1013)

CR (1013)

CR (1013)

ETX (1002)

CR (1013)

Baud Rate

9600

9600

9600

9600

9600

9600

9600

Parity

None

Even

None

Odd

Odd

Even

None

None

RTS/CTS
Option 3

None

RTS/CTS
Option 3

RTS/CTS Option 3

None

None

Software Handshaking

None

None

None

None

None

Ack/Nak

None

Serial Response Time-out

2 Sec.

9.9 Sec.

2 Sec.

9.9 Sec.

9.9 Sec.

9.9 Sec.

9.9 Sec.

Stop Bit Select

One

One

One

One

One

One

One

ASCII Format

8-Bit

8-Bit

8-Bit

8-Bit

8-Bit

7-Bit

8-Bit

Beep On 

Disable

Disable

Disable

Disable

Disable

Disable

Disable

Low

High

Low

Low

Low = No data to
send

Low

High

None

None

None

None

None

STX (1003)

None

Data Transmission Format

Hardware Handshaking

RTS Line State
Prefix

*In the Nixdorf Mode B, if CTS is Low, scanning is disabled. When CTS is High, the user can scan bar codes.
**If Nixdorf Mode B is scanned without the digital scanner connected to the proper host, it may appear unable to scan. If this happens, scan a different RS-232
host type within 5 seconds of cycling power to the digital scanner.

RS-232 Interface 7-7

RS-232 Host Parameters (continued)
Selecting ICL, Fujitsu, Wincor-Nixdorf Mode A, Wincor-Nixdorf Mode B, OPOS/JPOS, Olivetti, or Omron enables the transmission of
code ID characters listed in Table 7-3. These code ID characters are not programmable and are separate from the Transmit Code ID
feature. Do not enable the Transmit Code ID feature for these terminals.

Table 7-3. Terminal Specific Code ID Characters
ICL

WincorNixdorf
Mode B/
OPOS/JPOS

WincorNixdorf
Mode A

Fujitsu

Olivetti

Omron

UPC-A

A

A

A

A

A

A

UPC-E

E

E

C

C

C

E

EAN-8/JAN-8

FF

FF

B

B

B

FF

EAN-13/JAN-13

F

F

A

A

A

F

Code 39

C 

None

M

M

M 

C 

Codabar

N 

None

N

N

N 

N 

Code 128

L 

None

K

K

K 

L 

I 2 of 5

I 

None

I

I

I 

I 

Code 93

None

None

L

L

L 

None

D 2 of 5

H 

None

H

H

H 

H 

UCC/EAN 128

L 

None

P

P

P 

L 

MSI

None

None

O

O

O 

None

Bookland EAN

F

F

A

A

A

F

Trioptic

None

None

None

None

None

None

Code 11

None

None

None

None

None

None

IATA

H

None

H

H

None

None

Code 32

None

None

None

None

None

None

7-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

RS-232 Host Types
To select an RS-232 host interface, scan one of the following bar codes.

Standard RS-232

ICL RS-232

Wincor-Nixdorf RS-232 Mode A

Wincor-Nixdorf RS-232 Mode B

Olivetti ORS4500

Omron

RS-232 Interface 7-9

RS-232 Host Types (continued)

OPOS/JPOS

Fujitsu RS-232

Baud Rate
Baud rate is the number of bits of data transmitted per second. Set the digital scanner's baud rate to match the baud rate setting of
the host device. Otherwise, data may not reach the host device or may reach it in distorted form.

Baud Rate 600

Baud Rate 1200

Baud Rate 2400

Baud Rate 4800

7-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Baud Rate (continued)

*Baud Rate 9600

Baud Rate 19,200

Baud Rate 38,400

Baud Rate 57,600

RS-232 Interface 7-11

Parity
A parity check bit is the most significant bit of each ASCII coded character. Select the parity type according to host device
requirements.
•
•
•
•
•

Select Odd parity and the parity bit value is set to 0 or 1, based on data, to ensure that an odd number of 1 bits are contained
in the coded character.
Select Even parity and the parity bit value is set to 0 or 1, based on data, to ensure that an even number of 1 bits are
contained in the coded character.
Select Mark parity and the parity bit is always 1.
Select Space parity and the parity bit is always 0.
Select None when no parity bit is required.

Odd

Even

Mark

Space

*None

7-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Stop Bit Select
The stop bit(s) at the end of each transmitted character marks the end of transmission of one character and prepares the receiving
device for the next character in the serial data stream. The number of stop bits selected (one or two) depends on the number the
receiving terminal is programmed to accommodate. Set the number of stop bits to match host device requirements.

*1 Stop Bit

2 Stop Bits

Data Bits
This parameter allows the digital scanner to interface with devices requiring a 7-bit or 8-bit ASCII protocol.

7-Bit

*8-Bit

RS-232 Interface 7-13

Check Receive Errors
Select whether or not the parity, framing, and overrun of received characters are checked. The parity value of received characters is
verified against the parity parameter selected above.

*Check For Received Errors

Do Not Check For Received Errors

7-14 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Hardware Handshaking
The data interface consists of an RS-232 port designed to operate either with or without the hardware handshaking lines, Request to
Send (RTS), and Clear to Send (CTS).
If Standard RTS/CTS handshaking is not selected, scan data is transmitted as it becomes available. If Standard RTS/CTS handshaking
is selected, scan data is transmitted according to the following sequence:
•

•

•
•

The digital scanner reads the CTS line for activity. If CTS is asserted, the digital scanner waits up to Host Serial Response
Time-out for the host to de-assert the CTS line. If, after Host Serial Response Time-out (default), the CTS line is still asserted,
the digital scanner sounds a transmit error, and any scanned data is lost.
When the CTS line is de-asserted, the digital scanner asserts the RTS line and waits up to Host Serial Response Time-out
for the host to assert CTS. When the host asserts CTS, data is transmitted. If, after Host Serial Response Time-out (default),
the CTS line is not asserted, the digital scanner sounds a transmit error, and discards the data.
When data transmission is complete, the digital scanner de-asserts RTS 10 msec after sending the last character.
The host should respond by negating CTS. The digital scanner checks for a de-asserted CTS upon the next transmission of
data.

During the transmission of data, the CTS line should be asserted. If CTS is deasserted for more than 50 ms between characters, the
transmission is aborted, the digital scanner sounds a transmission error, and the data is discarded.
If the above communication sequence fails, the digital scanner issues an error indication. In this case, the data is lost and must be
rescanned.
If Hardware Handshaking and Software Handshaking are both enabled, Hardware Handshaking takes precedence.
The DTR signal is jumpered to the active state.

Note

•
•
•
•

•

None: Scan the bar code below if no Hardware Handshaking is desired.
Standard RTS/CTS: Scan the bar code below to select Standard RTS/CTS Hardware Handshaking.
RTS/CTS Option 1: When RTS/CTS Option 1 is selected, the digital scanner asserts RTS before transmitting and ignores
the state of CTS. The digital scanner de-asserts RTS when the transmission is complete.
RTS/CTS Option 2: When Option 2 is selected, RTS is always high or low (user-programmed logic level). However, the
digital scanner waits for CTS to be asserted before transmitting data. If CTS is not asserted within Host Serial Response
Time-out (default), the digital scanner issues an error indication and discards the data.
RTS/CTS Option 3: When Option 3 is selected, the digital scanner asserts RTS prior to any data transmission, regardless
of the state of CTS. The digital scanner waits up to Host Serial Response Time-out (default) for CTS to be asserted. If CTS is
not asserted during this time, the digital scanner issues an error indication and discards the data. The digital scanner deasserts RTS when transmission is complete.

RS-232 Interface 7-15

Hardware Handshaking (continued)

*None

Standard RTS/CTS

RTS/CTS Option 1

RTS/CTS Option 2

RTS/CTS Option 3

7-16 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Software Handshaking
This parameter offers control of the data transmission process in addition to, or instead of, that offered by hardware handshaking.
There are five options.
If Software Handshaking and Hardware Handshaking are both enabled, Hardware Handshaking takes precedence.
•
•

•

•
•

None: When this option is selected, data is transmitted immediately. No response is expected from host.
ACK/NAK: When this option is selected, after transmitting data, the digital scanner expects either an ACK or NAK response
from the host. When a NAK is received, the digital scanner transmits the same data again and waits for either an ACK or
NAK. After three unsuccessful attempts to send data when NAKs are received, the digital scanner issues an error indication
and discards the data.
The digital scanner waits up to the programmable Host Serial Response Time-out to receive an ACK or NAK. If the digital
scanner does not get a response in this time, it issues an error indication and discards the data. There are no retries when
a time-out occurs.
ENQ: hen this option is selected, the digital scanner waits for an ENQ character from the host before transmitting data. If
an ENQ is not received within the Host Serial Response Time-out, the digital scanner issues an error indication and discards
the data. The host must transmit an ENQ character at least every Host Serial Response Time-out to prevent transmission
errors.
ACK/NAK with ENQ: This combines the two previous options. For re-transmissions of data, due to a NAK from the host,
an additional ENQ is not required.
XON/XOFF: An XOFF character turns the digital scanner transmission off until the digital scanner receives an XON character.
There are two situations for XON/XOFF:
• XOFF is received before the digital scanner has data to send. When the digital scanner has data to send, it waits up to
Host Serial Response Time-out for an XON character before transmission. If the XON is not received within this time, the
digital scanner issues an error indication and discards the data.
• XOFF is received during a transmission. Data transmission then stops after sending the current byte. When the digital
scanner receives an XON character, it sends the rest of the data message. The digital scanner waits up to 30 seconds
for the XON.

*None

ACK/NAK

ENQ

RS-232 Interface 7-17

Software Handshaking (continued)

ACK/NAK with ENQ

XON/XOFF

Host Serial Response Time-out
This parameter specifies how long the digital scanner waits for an ACK, NAK, or CTS before determining that a transmission error
has occurred. This only applies when in one of the ACK/NAK Software Handshaking modes, or RTS/CTS Hardware Handshaking
option.

*Minimum: 2 Sec

Low: 2.5 Sec

Medium: 5 Sec

High: 7.5 Sec

7-18 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Host Serial Response Time-out (continued)

Maximum: 9.9 Sec

RTS Line State
This parameter sets the idle state of the Serial Host RTS line. Scan a bar code below to select Low RTS or High RTS line state.

*Host: Low RTS

Host: High RTS

Beep on 
When this parameter is enabled, the digital scanner issues a beep when a  character is detected on the RS-232 serial line.
 is issued to gain a user's attention to an illegal entry or other important event.

Beep On  Character
(Enable)

*Do Not Beep On  Character
(Disable)

RS-232 Interface 7-19

Intercharacter Delay
This parameter specifies the intercharacter delay inserted between character transmissions.

*Minimum: 0 msec

Low: 25 msec

Medium: 50 msec

High: 75 msec

Maximum: 99 msec

7-20 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Nixdorf Beep/LED Options
When Nixdorf Mode B is selected, this indicates when the digital scanner should beep and turn on its LED after a decode.

*Normal Operation
(Beep/LED immediately after decode)

Beep/LED After Transmission

Beep/LED After CTS Pulse

Ignore Unknown Characters
Unknown characters are characters the host does not recognize. When Send Bar Codes with Unknown Characters is selected,
all bar code data is send except for unknown characters, and no error beeps sound on the digital scanner. When Do Not Send Bar
Codes With Unknown Characters is selected, bar code data is sent up to the first unknown character and then an error beep will
sound on the digital scanner.

*Send Bar Code
(with unknown characters)

Do Not Send Bar Codes
(with unknown characters)

RS-232 Interface 7-21

ASCII Character Set for RS-232
The values in Table 7-4 can be assigned as prefixes or suffixes for ASCII character data transmission.

Table 7-4. Prefix/Suffix Values
Prefix/Suffix Value

Full ASCII
Code 39 Encode Character

ASCII Character

1000

%U

NUL

1001

$A

SOH

1002

$B

STX

1003

$C

ETX

1004

$D

EOT

1005

$E

ENQ

1006

$F

ACK

1007

$G

BELL

1008

$H

BCKSPC

1009

$I

HORIZ TAB

1010

$J

LF/NW LN

1011

$K

VT

1012

$L

FF

1013

$M

CR/ENTER

1014

$N

SO

1015

$O

SI

1016

$P

DLE

1017

$Q

DC1/XON

1018

$R

DC2

1019

$S

DC3/XOFF

1020

$T

DC4

1021

$U

NAK

1022

$V

SYN

1023

$W

ETB

1024

$X

CAN

1025

$Y

EM

1026

$Z

SUB

1027

%A

ESC

1028

%B

FS

1029

%C

GS

1030

%D

RS

1031

%E

US

1032

Space

Space

7-22 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 7-4. Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Prefix/Suffix Value

Full ASCII
Code 39 Encode Character

ASCII Character

1033

/A

!

1034

/B

"

1035

/C

#

1036

/D

$

1037

/E

%

1038

/F

&

1039

/G

‘

1040

/H

(

1041

/I

)

1042

/J

*

1043

/K

+

1044

/L

,

1045

-

-

1046

.

.

1047

/O

/

1048

0

0

1049

1

1

1050

2

2

1051

3

3

1052

4

4

1053

5

5

1054

6

6

1055

7

7

1056

8

8

1057

9

9

1058

/Z

:

1059

%F

;

1060

%G

<

1061

%H

=

1062

%I

>

1063

%J

?

1064

%V

@

1065

A

A

1066

B

B

1067

C

C

RS-232 Interface 7-23

Table 7-4. Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Prefix/Suffix Value

Full ASCII
Code 39 Encode Character

ASCII Character

1068

D

D

1069

E

E

1070

F

F

1071

G

G

1072

H

H

1073

I

I

1074

J

J

1075

K

K

1076

L

L

1077

M

M

1078

N

N

1079

O

O

1080

P

P

1081

Q

Q

1082

R

R

1083

S

S

1084

T

T

1085

U

U

1086

V

V

1087

W

W

1088

X

X

1089

Y

Y

1090

Z

Z

1091

%K

[

1092

%L

\

1093

%M

]

1094

%N

^

1095

%O

_

1096

%W

`

1097

+A

a

1098

+B

b

1099

+C

c

1100

+D

d

1101

+E

e

1102

+F

f

7-24 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 7-4. Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Prefix/Suffix Value

Full ASCII
Code 39 Encode Character

ASCII Character

1103

+G

g

1104

+H

h

1105

+I

i

1106

+J

j

1107

+K

k

1108

+L

l

1109

+M

m

1110

+N

n

1111

+O

o

1112

+P

p

1113

+Q

q

1114

+R

r

1115

+S

s

1116

+T

t

1117

+U

u

1118

+V

v

1119

+W

w

1120

+X

x

1121

+Y

y

1122

+Z

z

1123

%P

{

1124

%Q

|

1125

%R

}

1126

%S

~

1127

Undefined

7013

ENTER

USB Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
Connecting a USB Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
USB Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
USB Host Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
USB Device Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
USB Country Keyboard Types (Country Codes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
USB Keystroke Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
USB CAPS Lock Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
USB Ignore Unknown Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Emulate Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
USB Keyboard FN 1 Substitution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
Function Key Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
Simulated Caps Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
Convert Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
ASCII Character Set for USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12

8-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

USB Interface 8-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up the digital scanner with a USB host. The digital scanner connects directly to a USB host, or a
powered USB hub, and is powered by it. No additional power supply is required.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

Note

*North American Standard USB Keyboard

Feature/Option

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

Connecting a USB Interface

Interface Cable
USB Series A Connector

Figure 8-1. USB Connection
The digital scanner connects with USB-capable hosts including:
• Desktop PCs and notebooks
• Apple™ iMac, G4, iBooks (North America only)
• IBM SurePOS terminals
• Sun, IBM, and other network computers that support more than one keyboard.
The following operating systems support the digital scanner through USB:
• Windows® 98, 2000, ME, XP
• MacOS 8.5 and above
• IBM 4690 OS.
The digital scanner also interfaces with other USB hosts which support USB Human Interface Devices (HID). For more information on
USB technology, hosts, and peripheral devices, visit www.symbol.com/usb.

8-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

To set up the digital scanner:

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 8-1 are examples only.
The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain the
same.

1. Connect the modular connector of the USB interface cable to the cable interface port on the digital scanner (see Installing
the Interface Cable on page 1-4).
2. Plug the series A connector in the USB host or hub, or plug the Plus Power connector in an available port of the IBM SurePOS
terminal.
3. Select the USB device type by scanning the appropriate bar code from USB Device Type on page 8-5.
4. On first installation when using Windows, the software prompts to select or install the Human Interface Device driver. To
install this driver, provided by Windows, click Next through all the choices and click Finished on the last choice. The digital
scanner powers up during this installation.
5. To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.
If problems occur with the system, see Troubleshooting on page 3-3.

USB Parameter Defaults
Table 8-1 lists the defaults for USB host parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the Parameter
Descriptions section beginning on page 8-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 8-1. USB Host Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

USB Host Parameters
USB Device Type

HID Keyboard Emulation

8-5

USB Country Keyboard Types (Country Codes)

North American

8-6

USB Keystroke Delay

No Delay

8-8

USB CAPS Lock Override

Disable

8-8

USB Ignore Unknown Characters

Enable

8-9

Emulate Keypad

Disable

8-9

USB FN1 Substitution

Disable

8-10

Function Key Mapping

Disable

8-10

Simulated Caps Lock

Disable

8-11

Convert Case

None

8-11

USB Interface 8-5

USB Host Parameters
USB Device Type
Select the desired USB device type.
When changing USB Device Types, the digital scanner automatically resets. The digital scanner issues the
standard startup beep sequences.

Note

*HID Keyboard Emulation

IBM Table Top USB

IBM Hand-Held USB

USB OPOS Handheld

8-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

USB Country Keyboard Types (Country Codes)
Scan the bar code corresponding to the keyboard type. This setting applies only to the USB HID Keyboard Emulation device.
When changing USB country keyboard types the digital scanner automatically resets. The digital scanner
issues the standard startup beep sequences.

Note

*North American Standard USB Keyboard

German Windows

French Windows

French Canadian Windows 95/98

French Canadian Windows 2000/XP

USB Interface 8-7

USB Country Keyboard Types (continued)

Spanish Windows

Italian Windows

Swedish Windows

UK English Windows

Japanese Windows (ASCII)

Portuguese-Brazilian Windows

8-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

USB Keystroke Delay
This parameter sets the delay, in milliseconds, between emulated keystrokes. Scan a bar code below to increase the delay when hosts
require a slower transmission of data.

*No Delay

Medium Delay (20 msec)

Long Delay (40 msec)

USB CAPS Lock Override
This option applies only to the HID Keyboard Emulation device. When enabled, the case of the data is preserved regardless of the
state of the caps lock key. This setting is always enabled for the Japanese, Windows (ASCII) keyboard type and can not be disabled.

Override Caps Lock Key
(Enable)

*Do Not Override Caps Lock Key
(Disable)

USB Interface 8-9

USB Ignore Unknown Characters
This option applies only to the HID Keyboard Emulation device and IBM device. Unknown characters are characters the host does not
recognize. When Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters is selected, all bar code data is sent except for unknown characters,
and no error beeps sound. When Do Not Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters is selected, bar codes containing at least
one unknown character are not sent to the host, and an error beep sounds.

*Send Bar Codes with Unknown Characters
(Transmit)

Do Not Send Bar Codes with Unknown Characters
(Disable)

Emulate Keypad
When enabled, all characters are sent as ASCII sequences over the numeric keypad. For example ASCII A would be sent as “ALT
make” 0 6 5 “ALT Break”.

*Disable Keypad Emulation

Enable Keypad Emulation

8-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

USB Keyboard FN 1 Substitution
This option applies only to the USB HID Keyboard Emulation device. When enabled, this allows replacement of any FN 1 characters
in an EAN 128 bar code with a Key Category and value chosen by the user (see FN1 Substitution Values on page 14-8 to set the Key
Category and Key Value).

Enable

*Disable

Function Key Mapping
ASCII values under 32 are normally sent as a control-key sequences (see Table 8-2 on page 8-12). When this parameter is enabled,
the keys in bold are sent in place of the standard key mapping. Table entries that do not have a bold entry remain the same whether
or not this parameter is enabled.

*Disable Function Key Mapping

Enable Function Key Mapping

USB Interface 8-11

Simulated Caps Lock
When enabled, the digital scanner inverts upper and lower case characters on the bar code as if the Caps Lock state is enabled on
the keyboard. This inversion is done regardless of the current state of the keyboard’s Caps Lock state.

*Disable Simulated Caps Lock

Enable Simulated Caps Lock

Convert Case
When enabled, the digital scanner converts all bar code data to the selected case.

*No Case Conversion

Convert All to Upper Case

Convert All to Lower Case

8-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

ASCII Character Set for USB
Table 8-2. USB Prefix/Suffix Values
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char.acter

Prefix/ Suffix Value

Keystroke

1000

%U

CTRL 2

1001

$A

CTRL A

1002

$B

CTRL B

1003

$C

CTRL C

1004

$D

CTRL D

1005

$E

CTRL E

1006

$F

CTRL F

1007

$G

CTRL G

1008

$H

CTRL H/BACKSPACE1

1009

$I

CTRL I/HORIZONTAL
TAB1

1010

$J

CTRL J

1011

$K

CTRL K

1012

$L

CTRL L

1013

$M

CTRL M/ENTER1

1014

$N

CTRL N

1015

$O

CTRL O

1016

$P

CTRL P

1017

$Q

CTRL Q

1018

$R

CTRL R

1019

$S

CTRL S

1020

$T

CTRL T

1021

$U

CTRL U

1022

$V

CTRL V

1023

$W

CTRL W

1024

$X

CTRL X

1025

$Y

CTRL Y

1026

$Z

CTRL Z

1027

%A

CTRL [/ESC1

1028

%B

CTRL \

1029

%C

CTRL ]

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

USB Interface 8-13

Table 8-2. USB Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char.acter

Prefix/ Suffix Value

Keystroke

1030

%D

CTRL 6

1031

%E

CTRL -

1032

Space

Space

1033

/A

!

1034

/B

“

1035

/C

#

1036

/D

$

1037

/E

%

1038

/F

&

1039

/G

‘

1040

/H

(

1041

/I

)

1042

/J

*

1043

/K

+

1044

/L

,

1045

-

-

1046

.

.

1047

/O

/

1048

0

0

1049

1

1

1050

2

2

1051

3

3

1052

4

4

1053

5

5

1054

6

6

1055

7

7

1056

8

8

1057

9

9

1058

/Z

:

1059

%F

;

1060

%G

<

1061

%H

=

1062

%I

>

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

8-14 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 8-2. USB Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char.acter

Prefix/ Suffix Value

Keystroke

1063

%J

?

1064

%V

@

1065

A

A

1066

B

B

1067

C

C

1068

D

D

1069

E

E

1070

F

F

1071

G

G

1072

H

H

1073

I

I

1074

J

J

1075

K

K

1076

L

L

1077

M

M

1078

N

N

1079

O

O

1080

P

P

1081

Q

Q

1082

R

R

1083

S

S

1084

T

T

1085

U

U

1086

V

V

1087

W

W

1088

X

X

1089

Y

Y

1090

Z

Z

1091

%K

[

1092

%L

\

1093

%M

]

1094

%N

^

1095

%O

_

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

USB Interface 8-15

Table 8-2. USB Prefix/Suffix Values (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char.acter

Prefix/ Suffix Value

Keystroke

1096

%W

`

1097

+A

a

1098

+B

b

1099

+C

c

1100

+D

d

1101

+E

e

1102

+F

f

1103

+G

g

1104

+H

h

1105

+I

i

1106

+J

j

1107

+K

k

1108

+L

l

1109

+M

m

1110

+N

n

1111

+O

o

1112

+P

p

1113

+Q

q

1114

+R

r

1115

+S

s

1116

+T

t

1117

+U

u

1118

+V

v

1119

+W

w

1120

+X

x

1121

+Y

y

1122

+Z

z

1123

%P

{

1124

%Q

|

1125

%R

}

1126

%S

~

1The keystroke in bold is sent only if the “Function Key Mapping” is enabled. Otherwise,

the unbolded keystroke is sent.

8-16 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 8-3. USB ALT Key Character Set
ALT Keys

Keystroke

2064

ALT 2

2065

ALT A

2066

ALT B

2067

ALT C

2068

ALT D

2069

ALT E

2070

ALT F

2071

ALT G

2072

ALT H

2073

ALT I

2074

ALT J

2075

ALT K

2076

ALT L

2077

ALT M

2078

ALT N

2079

ALT O

2080

ALT P

2081

ALT Q

2082

ALT R

2083

ALT S

2084

ALT T

2085

ALT U

2086

ALT V

2087

ALT W

2088

ALT X

2089

ALT Y

2090

ALT Z

USB Interface 8-17

Table 8-4. USB GUI Key Character Set
GUI Key

Keystroke

3000

Right Control Key

3048

GUI 0

3049

GUI 1

3050

GUI 2

3051

GUI 3

3052

GUI 4

3053

GUI 5

3054

GUI 6

3055

GUI 7

3056

GUI 8

3057

GUI 9

3065

GUI A

3066

GUI B

3067

GUI C

3068

GUI D

3069

GUI E

3070

GUI F

3071

GUI G

3072

GUI H

3073

GUI I

3074

GUI J

3075

GUI K

3076

GUI L

3077

GUI M

3078

GUI N

3079

GUI O

3080

GUI P

3081

GUI Q

3082

GUI R

3083

GUI S

3084

GUI T

3085

GUI U

3086

GUI V

Note: GUI Shift Keys - The Apple™ iMac keyboard has an apple key on either side of the space
bar. Windows-based systems have a GUI key to the left of the left ALT key, and to the right of the
right ALT key.

8-18 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 8-4. USB GUI Key Character Set (Continued)
GUI Key

Keystroke

3087

GUI W

3088

GUI X

3089

GUI Y

3090

GUI Z

Note: GUI Shift Keys - The Apple™ iMac keyboard has an apple key on either side of the space
bar. Windows-based systems have a GUI key to the left of the left ALT key, and to the right of the
right ALT key.

Table 8-5. USB F Key Character Set
F Keys

Keystroke

5001

F1

5002

F2

5003

F3

5004

F4

5005

F5

5006

F6

5007

F7

5008

F8

5009

F9

5010

F10

5011

F11

5012

F12

5013

F13

5014

F14

5015

F15

5016

F16

5017

F17

5018

F18

5019

F19

5020

F20

5021

F21

5022

F22

5023

F23

5024

F24

USB Interface 8-19

Table 8-6. USB Numeric Keypad Character Set
Numeric Keypad

Keystroke

6042

*

6043

+

6044

undefined

6045

-

6046

.

6047

/

6048

0

6049

1

6050

2

6051

3

6052

4

6053

5

6054

6

6055

7

6056

8

6057

9

6058

Enter

6059

Num Lock

8-20 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 8-7. USB Extended Keypad Character Set
Extended Keypad

Keystroke

7001

Break

7002

Delete

7003

PgUp

7004

End

7005

Pg Dn

7006

Pause

7007

Scroll Lock

7008

Backspace

7009

Tab

7010

Print Screen

7011

Insert

7012

Home

7013

Enter

7014

Escape

7015

Up Arrow

7016

Down Arrow

7017

Left Arrow

7018

Right Arrow

IBM 468X/469X Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Connecting to an IBM 468X/469X Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
IBM Parameter Defaults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
IBM 468X/469X Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Port Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5
Convert Unknown to Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6

9-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

IBM 468X/469X Interface 9-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up the digital scanner with an IBM 468X/469X host.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

Note

*Disable Convert to Code 39

Feature/Option

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the
screen, be sure to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and
bars and/or spaces are not merging.

Connecting to an IBM 468X/469X Host
This connection is made directly from the digital scanner to the host interface.

Interface Cable

Host Port Connector

Figure 9-1. IBM Direct Connection

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 9-1 are examples only.
The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain the
same.

1. Attach the modular connector of the IBM 46XX interface cable to the cable interface port on the digital scanner (see
Installing the Interface Cable on page 1-4).
2. Connect the other end of the IBM 46XX interface cable to the appropriate port on the host (typically Port 9).
3. Select the port address by scanning the appropriate bar code from Port Address on page 9-5.
4. To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.

9-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

The only required configuration is the port address. Other digital scanner parameters are typically controlled
by the IBM system.

Note

IBM Parameter Defaults
Table 9-1 lists the defaults for IBM host parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the Parameter
Descriptions section beginning on page 9-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 9-1. IBM Host Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

IBM 468X/469X Host Parameters
Port Address

None Selected

9-5

Convert Unknown to Code 39

Disable

9-6

IBM 468X/469X Interface 9-5

IBM 468X/469X Host Parameters
Port Address
This parameter sets the IBM 468X/469X port used.
Scanning one of these bar codes enables the RS-485 interface on the digital scanner.

Note

None Selected

Hand-held Scanner Emulation (Port 9B)

Non-IBM Scanner Emulation (Port 5B)

Table-top Scanner Emulation (Port 17)

9-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Convert Unknown to Code 39
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable the conversion of unknown bar code type data to Code 39.

Enable Convert Unknown to Code 39

*Disable Convert Unknown to Code 39

Wand Emulation Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Connecting Using Wand Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Wand Emulation Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Wand Emulation Host Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5
Wand Emulation Host Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5
Leading Margin (Quiet Zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7
Ignore Unknown Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7
Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Convert Code 39 to Full ASCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9

10-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Wand Emulation Interface

10-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up the digital scanner with a wand emulation host when Wand Emulation communication is needed.
The digital scanner connects to an external wand decoder or to a decoder integrated in a mobile computer or Point-of-Sale (POS)
terminal.
In this mode the digital scanner emulates the signal of a digital wand to make it "readable" by a wand decoder.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

*Transmit Unknown

Feature/Option

Characters

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

Connecting Using Wand Emulation
To perform Wand Emulation, connect the digital scanner to a mobile computer, or a controller which collects the wand data and
interprets it for the host.

Mobile Computer

Wand Port

Interface Cable

Figure 10-1. Wand Emulation Connection

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 10-1 are examples
only. The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain
the same.

10-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

1. Attach the modular connector of the Wand Emulation interface cable to cable interface port on the digital scanner (see
Installing the Interface Cable on page 1-4).
2. Connect the other end of the Wand Emulation interface cable to the wand port on the mobile computer or controller.
3. Select the Wand Emulation host type by scanning the appropriate bar code from Wand Emulation Host Types on page 10-5.
4. To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.
Connect the digital scanner to 5 volt decoders only. Connecting the digital scanner to a 12 volt
decoder can damage the digital scanner and invalidate the warranty.

WARNING

Wand Emulation Parameter Defaults
Table 10-1 lists the defaults for Wand Emulation host types. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in Wand
Emulation Host Parameters on page 10-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 10-1. Wand Emulation Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

Wand Emulation Host Parameters
Wand Emulation Host Types

Symbol OmniLink Interface
Controller

10-5

Leading Margin

80 msec

10-6

Polarity

Bar High/Margin Low

10-7

Ignore Unknown Characters

Ignore

10-7

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39

Disable

10-8

Convert Code 39 to Full ASCII

Disable

10-9

Wand Emulation Interface

Wand Emulation Host Parameters
Wand Emulation Host Types
Select a Wand Emulation host by scanning one of the bar codes below.

Symbol OmniLink Interface Controller

Symbol PDT Terminal (MSI)

Symbol PTC Terminal (Telxon)

10-5

10-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Leading Margin (Quiet Zone)
Scan a bar code below to select a leading margin duration. A leading margin is the time that precedes the first bar of the scan, (in
milliseconds). The minimum allowed value is 80 msec and the maximum is 250 msec. This parameter accommodates older wand
decoders which cannot handle short leading margins.
250 msec is the maximum value that this parameter can attain, however, 200 msec is sufficient.

Note

*80 msec

140 msec

200 msec

Wand Emulation Interface

10-7

Polarity
Polarity determines how the digital scanner's Wand Emulation interface creates the Digitized Barcode Pattern (DBP). DBP is a digital
signal that represents the scanned bar code. Different decoders expect the DBP to be in a certain format. The DBP either has the
"highs" represent bars and the "lows" represent spaces (margins), or the "highs" represent spaces (margins) and the "lows" represent
bars.
Scan the appropriate bar code to select the polarity required by the decoder.

*Bar High/Margin Low

Bar Low/Margin High

Ignore Unknown Characters
Unknown characters are characters the host does not recognize. When Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters is selected,
all bar code data is sent except for unknown characters, and no error beeps sound on the digital scanner. When Do Not Send Bar
Codes With Unknown Characters is selected, bar codes containing at least one unknown character are not sent to the host, and
the digital scanner emits an error beep.

*Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters
(Transmit)

Do Not Send Bar Codes With Unknown Characters
(Do Not Transmit)

10-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39
By default, the Wand Emulation interface sends data to the attached host in the same symbology that was decoded. This can be a
problem for customers with older systems that do not recognize newer symbologies (for example, RSS).
Enabling this parameter ignores the original symbology decoded, and outputs the data as if it were a Code 39 bar code. Any lowercase
characters in the original data stream are transmitted as uppercase characters. This also allows ADF Formatting.
If Ignore Unknown Characters is enabled, any characters that do not have a corresponding character in the Code 39 symbology
set are replaced by a space.
If Ignore Unknown Characters is disabled, if any characters that do not have a corresponding Code 39 character are encountered,
the digital scanner emits an error beep and no data is transmitted.

Note

ADF Note: By default, the Wand Emulation interface does not allow scanned data to be processed by ADF
rules. Enabling this parameter allows the scanned data to be processed by ADF rules (Chapter 15, Advanced
Data Formatting).

Enable Convert to Code 39 for Wand Host

*Disable Convert to Code 39 for Wand Host

Wand Emulation Interface

10-9

Convert Code 39 to Full ASCII
By default, any characters that do not have a corresponding character in the Code 39 symbology set are replaced by a space. If this
parameter is enabled, the data sent to the wand Interface is encoded in Code 39 Full ASCII. This setting requires that the Host be
able to interpret Code 39 Full ASCII data.
This setting applies only if Convert to Code 39 is also enabled.

*Disable Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

Enable Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

10-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanner Emulation Interface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Connecting Using Scanner Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Scanner Emulation Parameter Defaults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
Scanner Emulation Host. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
Scanner Emulation Host Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
Beep Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
Parameter Pass-Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
Convert Newer Code Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
Module Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
Transmission Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
Ignore Unknown Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10
Leading Margin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11
Check For Decode LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12

11-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanner Emulation Interface 11-3

Introduction
This chapter describes how to set up the digital scanner with a Scanner Emulation host. Use this mode when Scanner Emulation
communication is needed. In this mode, the digital scanner connects to an external decoder or to a decoder integrated in a mobile
computer or Point-of-Sale (POS) terminal.
Throughout the programming bar code menus, default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

*Parameter Process and

Feature/Option

Pass-Through

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

Connecting Using Scanner Emulation
To perform Scanner Emulation, connect the digital scanner to a mobile computer, or a controller which collects the data and interprets
it for the host.
Host Port Connector

Interface Cable

Figure 11-1. Scanner Emulation Connection

Note

Interface cables vary depending on configuration. The connectors illustrated in Figure 11-1 are examples
only. The connectors may be different than those illustrated, but the steps to connect the scanner remain
the same.

1. Attach the modular connector of the Scanner Emulation interface cable to the cable interface port on the digital scanner (see
Installing the Interface Cable on page 1-4).
2. Connect the other end of the Scanner Emulation interface cable to the scanner port on the mobile computer or controller.

11-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

3. Scan the Scanner Emulation Host bar code from Scanner Emulation Host on page 11-6 to enable the Scanner Emulation host
interface.
4. To modify any other parameter options, scan the appropriate bar codes in this chapter.
Connect the digital scanner to 5 volt decoders only. Connecting the digital scanner to a 12 volt
decoder can damage the digital scanner and invalidate the warranty.

WARNING

Scanner Emulation Parameter Defaults
Table 11-1 lists the defaults for the Scanner Emulation host. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the
Scanner Emulation Host Parameters section beginning on page 11-6.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note

Scanner Emulation Interface 11-5

Table 11-1. Scanner Emulation Default Table
Parameter

Default

Page Number

Beep Style

Beep on Successful Transmit

11-6

Parameter Pass-Through

Parameter Process and Pass
Through

11-7

Convert Newer Code Types

Convert Newer Code Types

11-7

Module Width

20 µs

11-8

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39

Do Not Convert to Bar Codes
to Code 39

11-8

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

Disable

11-9

Transmission Timeout

3 seconds

11-9

Ignore Unknown Characters

Ignore Unknown Characters

11-10

Leading Margin

2 ms

11-11

Check for Decode LED

Check for Decode LED

11-12

11-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanner Emulation Host
Scan the bar code below to enable the Scanner Emulation host.

Scanner Emulation Host

Scanner Emulation Host Parameters
Beep Style
The Scanner Emulation host supports three beep styles.
•
•

•

Beep On Successful Transmit: The digital scanner beeps when the attached decoder issues the decode signal to the
digital scanner, so the digital scanner and the attached decoder beep at the same time.
Beep At Decode Time: The digital scanner beeps upon decode. This results in a double beep sequence from most
decoders, since the digital scanner beeps, and the decoder beeps (at a different frequency) when it successfully decodes the
output.
Do Not Beep: Only the attached decoder issues the decode beep.

In all cases, if an error occurs, the digital scanner issues error beeps.

*Beep On Successful Transmit

Beep At Decode Time

Do Not Beep

Scanner Emulation Interface 11-7

Parameter Pass-Through
The Scanner Emulation host can process parameter bar code messages and send them to the attached decoder. In this way, customers
using Symbol compliant decoders can control the behavior of the entire system by scanning the necessary parameters only once.
For example, to enable D 2 of 5, scan the D 2 of 5 Enable parameter bar code. The digital scanner and the attached decoder both
process the parameter.

*Parameter Process and Pass-Through

Parameter Process Only

Convert Newer Code Types
The digital scanner supports a variety of code types that are not decodable by attached decoder systems. To allow compatibility in
these environments, the digital scanner converts these code types to more commonly decodable symbologies, as per the following
chart. Symbologies not listed on this chart are transmitted normally.
Scan this code type:

Transmitted as:

Code 11

Code 39

RSS (14, Limited, and Expanded), Coupon Code, PDF,
MicroPDF, MaxiCode, DataMatrix, QR Code, Postal
Codes, Composite Codes

Code 128

When decoding these code types with this parameter disabled, the digital scanner issues Convert Error beeps and transmits no data.

*Convert Newer Code Types

Reject Newer Code Types

11-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Module Width
The standard module width is 20 µs. For an extremely slow decoder system, select 50 µs Module Width.

*20 µs Module Width

50 µs Module Width

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable the conversion of all bar code data to Code 39.

*Do Not Convert Bar Codes To Code 39

Convert All To Code 39

Scanner Emulation Interface 11-9

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion
By default, any characters that do not have a corresponding character in the Code 39 symbology set are replaced by a space. If this
parameter is enabled, the data sent to the Scanner Emulation host is encoded in Code 39 Full ASCII. The host must be able to interpret
Code 39 Full ASCII data.
This setting applies only if Convert to Code 39 is also enabled.

*Disable Convert Code 39 To Full ASCII

Enable Convert Code 39 To Full ASCII

Transmission Timeout
The Scanner Emulation host transmits bar code data to the attached decoder and waits for the decoder to assert the Decode signal,
indicating successful transmission. If, after a specified amount of time, the Decode signal is not asserted (indicating that the attached
decoder has not successfully received the bar code data), the digital scanner issues transmit error beeps.
Scan the appropriate bar code below to select the desired transmission timeout.

*3 Second Transmission Timeout

4 Second Transmission Timeout

5 Second Transmission Timeout

11-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Transmission Timeout (continued)

10 Second Transmission Timeout

30 Second Transmission Timeout

Ignore Unknown Characters
Unknown characters are characters the decoder does not recognize. When Ignore Unknown Characters is selected, all bar code
data is sent except for unknown characters, and no error beeps sound. When Convert Error on Unknown Characters is selected,
bar codes containing at least one unknown character are not sent to the decoder, and a convert error beep sounds.

*Ignore Unknown Characters

Convert Error On Unknown Characters

Scanner Emulation Interface 11-11

Leading Margin
Scan a bar code below to select a leading margin duration.

1 ms Leading Margin

*2 ms Leading Margin

3 ms Leading Margin

5 ms Leading Margin

10 ms Leading Margin

11-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Check For Decode LED
The attached decoder normally asserts the Decode line to signal to the Scanner Emulation host that it successfully decoded the
transmitted bar code. Some decoders, however, do not assert the Decode signal. In this case, the digital scanner emits transmit error
beeps to indicate that the bar code was not successfully transmitted. Scan the Ignore Decode LED bar code to disable the Transmit
Error beeps.

*Check For Decode LED

Ignore Decode LED

123 Scan
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
Communication with 123Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
123Scan Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3

12-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guid

123 Scan 12-3

Introduction
123Scan is a Windows®-based utility that programs the digital scanner with all parameters including Advanced Data Formatting
(ADF) Rules. An ADF rule modifies bar code data before it is sent to the host to ensure compatibility between bar coded data and the
host application. Digital scanners can be programmed via PC download or by scanning a sheet of bar codes generated by the utility.
Digital scanner programming is saved in a file for electronic distribution. The 123Scan program includes a help file.

Communication with 123Scan
To communicate with the 123Scan program which runs on a host computer running a Windows operating system, use an RS-232 cable
to connect the digital scanner to the host computer (see Connecting an RS-232 Interface on page 7-4).
123Scan requirements:
•
•
•

Host computer with Windows 98, Windows NT, Windows 2000, or Windows XP
Digital scanner
RS-232 cable.

123Scan Parameter
To communicate with the 123Scan program, load 123Scan, included in the documentation CD-ROM, onto the host computer, and scan
the bar code below. Refer to 123Scan instructions for programming the digital scanner.
Scan the bar code below to enable the 123Scan interface on the digital scanner.

123Scan Configuration

12-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guid

Symbologies
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
Symbology Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Enable/Disable UPC-E1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Enable/Disable EAN-8/JAN-8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Enable/Disable EAN-13/JAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
Enable/Disable Bookland EAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Transmit UPC-A Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15
Transmit UPC-E Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15
Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
UPC-A Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
UPC-E Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17
UPC-E1 Preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18
Convert UPC-E to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18
Convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-19
EAN-8/JAN-8 Extend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-19
UCC Coupon Extended Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
Code 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
Enable/Disable Code 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20

13-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Enable/Disable UCC/EAN-128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21
Enable/Disable ISBT 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21
Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-22
Enable/Disable Trioptic Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-22
Convert Code 39 to Code 32. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-23
Code 32 Prefix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-23
Set Lengths for Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-24
Code 39 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-25
Transmit Code 39 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
Code 39 Buffering (Scan & Store) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-27
Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-29
Enable/Disable Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-29
Set Lengths for Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-30
Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-31
Code 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-31
Set Lengths for Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-32
Code 11 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-33
Transmit Code 11 Check Digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34
Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34
Enable/Disable Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-34
Set Lengths for Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-35
I 2 of 5 Check Digit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-36
Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-37
Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-37
Discrete 2 of 5 (DTF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Enable/Disable Discrete 2 of 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Set Lengths for Discrete 2 of 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
Codabar (NW - 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-39
Enable/Disable Codabar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-39
Set Lengths for Codabar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-40
CLSI Editing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
NOTIS Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
Enable/Disable MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
Set Lengths for MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42
MSI Check Digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-43
Transmit MSI Check Digit(s). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-44
MSI Check Digit Algorithm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-44
Postal Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
US Postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
US Planet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-45
UK Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-46
Transmit UK Postal Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-46
Japan Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-47
Australian Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-47
Dutch Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-48
Transmit US Postal Check Digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-48

Symbologies 13-3

RSS (Reduced Space Symbology). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS-14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS Limited . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-49
RSS Expanded. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-50
Convert RSS to UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-50
Composite. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite CC-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite CC-A/B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
Composite TLC-39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-52
UPC Composite Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-53
Composite Beep Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-54
UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for UCC/EAN Composite Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-54
2D Symbologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Enable/Disable PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Enable/Disable MicroPDF417. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
Code 128 Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-56
Data Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
QR Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-58
Redundancy Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-59
Security Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-61
Intercharacter Gap Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-62
Report Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-62
Macro PDF Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63
Flush Macro Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63
Abort Macro PDF Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-63

13-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Symbologies 13-5

Introduction
This chapter describes symbology features and provides the programming bar codes for selecting these features. Before
programming, follow the instructions in Chapter 1, Getting Started.
The digital scanner is shipped with the settings shown in the Symbology Default Table on page 13-6 (also see Appendix A, Standard
Default Parameters for all host device and miscellaneous defaults). If the default values suit requirements, programming is not
necessary.
To set feature values, scan a single bar code or a short bar code sequence. The settings are stored in non-volatile memory and are
preserved even when the digital scanner is powered down.

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the
screen, be sure to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and
bars and/or spaces are not merging.

If not using a Synapse or USB cable, select a host type (see each host chapter for specific host information) after the
power-up beeps sound. This is only necessary upon the first power-up when connected to a new host.
To return all features to default values, scan the *Set All Defaults bar code on page 4-5. Throughout the programming bar code menus,
default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

*Enable UPC-A

Feature/Option

Scanning Sequence Examples
In most cases, scanning one bar code sets the parameter value. For example, to transmit bar code data without the UPC-A check digit,
simply scan the Do Not Transmit UPC-A Check Digit bar code under Transmit UPC-A Check Digit on page 13-15. The digital scanner
issues a fast warble beep and the LED turns green, signifying a successful parameter entry.
Other parameters, such as Set Length(s) for D 2 of 5 require scanning several bar codes. See the individual parameter, such as Set
Length(s) for D 2 of 5, for this procedure.

Errors While Scanning
Unless otherwise specified, to correct an error during a scanning sequence, just re-scan the correct parameter.

13-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Symbology Parameter Defaults
Table 13-1 lists the defaults for all symbologies parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s) provided in the
Symbologies Parameters section beginning on 13-10.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, and miscellaneous default
parameters.

Note
Table 13-1. Symbology Default Table
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

UPC/EAN
UPC-A

01h

Enable

13-10

UPC-E

02h

Enable

13-10

UPC-E1

0Ch

Disable

13-11

EAN-8/JAN 8

04h

Enable

13-11

EAN-13/JAN 13

03h

Enable

13-12

Bookland EAN

53h

Disable

13-12

Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals (2 and 5 digits)

10h

Ignore

13-13

UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy

50h

10

13-14

Transmit UPC-A Check Digit

28h

Enable

13-15

Transmit UPC-E Check Digit

29h

Enable

13-15

Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit

2Ah

Enable

13-16

UPC-A Preamble

22h

System Character

13-16

UPC-E Preamble

23h

System Character

13-16

UPC-E1 Preamble

24h

System Character

13-18

Convert UPC-E to A

25h

Disable

13-19

Convert UPC-E1 to A

26h

Disable

13-19

EAN-8/JAN-8 Extend

27h

Disable

13-19

UCC Coupon Extended Code

55h

Disable

13-20

Code 128

08h

Enable

13-20

UCC/EAN-128

0Eh

Enable

13-21

ISBT 128

54h

Enable

13-21

Code 128

Symbologies 13-7

Table 13-1. Symbology Default Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Code 39
Code 39

00h

Enable

13-22

Trioptic Code 39

0Dh

Disable

13-22

Convert Code 39 to Code 32 (Italian Pharmacy Code)

56h

Disable

13-23

Code 32 Prefix

E7h

Disable

13-23

Set Length(s) for Code 39

12h 13h

2 to 55

13-24

Code 39 Check Digit Verification

30h

Disable

13-25

Transmit Code 39 Check Digit

2Bh

Disable

13-26

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

11h

Disable

13-26

Buffer Code 39

71h

Disable

13-27

Code 93

09h

Disable

13-29

Set Length(s) for Code 93

1Ah 1Bh

4 to 55

13-30

Code 11

0Ah

Disable

13-31

Set Lengths for Code 11

1Ch 1Dh

4 to 55

13-32

Code 11 Check Digit Verification

34h

Disable

13-33

Transmit Code 11 Check Digit(s)

2Fh

Disable

13-34

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF)

06h

Enable

13-34

Set Lengths for I 2 of 5

16h 17h

14

13-35

I 2 of 5 Check Digit Verification

31h

Disable

13-36

Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit

2Ch

Disable

13-37

Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN 13

52h

Disable

13-37

Discrete 2 of 5

05h

Disable

13-38

Set Length(s) for D 2 of 5

14h 15h

12

13-38

Code 93

Code 11

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF)

Discrete 2 of 5 (DTF)

13-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 13-1. Symbology Default Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Codabar (NW - 7)
Codabar

07h

Disable

13-39

Set Lengths for Codabar

18h 19h

5 to 55

13-40

CLSI Editing

36h

Disable

13-41

NOTIS Editing

37h

Disable

13-41

MSI

0Bh

Disable

13-42

Set Length(s) for MSI

1Eh 1Fh

1 to 55

13-42

MSI Check Digits

32h

One

13-43

Transmit MSI Check Digit

2Eh

Disable

13-44

MSI Check Digit Algorithm

33h

Mod 10/Mod 10

13-44

US Postnet

59h

Enable

13-45

US Planet

5Ah

Enable

13-45

UK Postal

5Bh

Enable

13-46

Transmit UK Postal Check Digit

60h

Enable

13-46

Japan Postal

F0h 22h

Enable

13-47

Australian Postal

F0h 23h

Enable

13-47

Dutch Postal

F0h 46h

Enable

13-48

Transmit US Postal Check Digit

5Fh

Enable

13-48

RSS 14

F0h 52h

Enable

13-49

RSS Limited

F0h 53h

Enable

13-49

RSS Expanded

F0h 54h

Enable

13-50

Convert RSS to UPC/EAN

F0h 8Dh

Disable

13-50

Composite CC-C

F0h 55h

Disable

13-51

Composite CC-A/B

F0h 56h

Disable

13-51

MSI

Postal Codes

RSS (Reduced Space Symbology)

Composite

Symbologies 13-9

Table 13-1. Symbology Default Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Composite TLC-39

F0h 73h

Disable

13-52

UPC Composite Mode

F0h 58h

Always Linked

13-53

Composite Beep Mode

F0h 8Eh

Beep As Each Code Type is
Decoded

13-54

UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for UCC/EAN
Composite Codes

F0h ABh

Disable

13-54

PDF417

0Fh

Enable

13-55

MicroPDF417

E3h

Disable

13-55

Code 128 Emulation

7Bh

Disable

13-56

Data Matrix

F0h 24h

Enable

13-57

Maxicode

F0h 26h

Enable

13-57

QR Code

F0h 25h

Enable

13-58

Redundancy Level

4Eh

1

13-59

Security Level

4Dh

0

13-61

Intercharacter Gap Size

F0h 7Dh

Normal

13-62

2D Symbologies

Symbology-Specific Security Levels

Report Version

13-62

Macro PDF
Flush Macro PDF Buffer

13-63

Abort Macro PDF Entry

13-63

13-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

UPC/EAN
Enable/Disable UPC-A
Parameter # 01h
To enable or disable UPC-A, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable UPC-A
(01h)

Disable UPC-A
(00h)

Enable/Disable UPC-E
Parameter # 02h
To enable or disable UPC-E, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable UPC-E
(01h)

Disable UPC-E
(00h)

Symbologies 13-11

Enable/Disable UPC-E1
Parameter # 0Ch
UPC-E1 is disabled by default.
To enable or disable UPC-E1, scan the appropriate bar code below.
UPC-E1 is not a UCC (Uniform Code Council) approved symbology.

Note

Enable UPC-E1
(01h)

*Disable UPC-E1
(00h)

Enable/Disable EAN-8/JAN-8
Parameter # 04h
To enable or disable EAN-8/JAN-8, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable EAN-8/JAN-8
(01h)

Disable EAN-8/JAN-8
(00h)

13-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Enable/Disable EAN-13/JAN-13
Parameter # 03h
To enable or disable EAN-13/JAN-13, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable EAN-13/JAN-13
(01h)

Disable EAN-13/JAN-13
(00h)

Enable/Disable Bookland EAN
Parameter # 53h
To enable or disable Bookland EAN, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Bookland EAN
(01h)

*Disable Bookland EAN
(00h)

Symbologies 13-13

Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals
Parameter # 10h
Supplementals are bar codes appended according to specific format conventions (e.g., UPC A+2, UPC E+2, EAN 13+2). Six options are
available.
•
•
•
•

•

•

If Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Only With Supplementals is selected, UPC/EAN/JAN symbols without supplementals are not
decoded.
If Ignore Supplementals is selected, and the digital scanner is presented with a UPC/EAN/JAN with a
supplemental, the UPC/EAN/JAN is decoded and the supplemental bar code is ignored.
An Autodiscriminate Option is also available. If this option is selected, choose an appropriate UPC/EAN/JAN
Supplemental Redundancy value from the next page. A value of 5 or more is recommended.
Enable 378/379 Supplemental Mode to delay only EAN-13/JAN-13 bar codes starting with a ‘378’ or ‘379’ prefix by the
supplemental search process. All other UPC/EAN/JAN bar codes are exempt from the search and are reported instantly upon
decode.
Select Enable 978 Supplemental Mode to delay only EAN-13/JAN-13 bar codes starting with a ‘978’ prefix by the
supplemental search process. All other UPC/EAN/JAN bar codes are exempt from the search and are reported instantly upon
decode.
Select Enable Smart Supplemental Mode to delay only EAN-13/JAN-13 bar codes starting with a ‘378’, ‘379’, or ‘978’
prefix by the supplemental search process. All other UPC/EAN/JAN bar codes are exempt from the search and are reported
instantly upon decode.
To minimize the risk of invalid data transmission, select either to decode or ignore supplemental characters.

Note

Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Only With Supplementals
(01h)

*Ignore Supplementals
(00h)

Autodiscriminate UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals
(02h)

13-14 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals (continued)

Enable 378/379 Supplemental Mode
(04h)

Enable 978 Supplemental Mode
(05h)

Enable Smart Supplemental Mode
(03h)

UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy
Parameter # 50h
With Autodiscriminate UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals selected, this option adjusts the number of times a symbol without
supplementals is decoded before transmission. The range is from two to thirty times. Five or above is recommended when decoding
a mix of UPC/EAN/JAN symbols with and without supplementals, and the autodiscriminate option is selected. The default is set at 10.
Scan the bar code below to set a decode redundancy value. Next, scan two numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes.
Single digit numbers must have a leading zero. To correct an error or change a selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.

UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy

Symbologies 13-15

Transmit UPC-A Check Digit
Parameter # 28h
The check digit is the last character of the symbol used to verify the integrity of the data. Scan the appropriate bar code below to
transmit the bar code data with or without the UPC-A check digit. It is always verified to guarantee the integrity of the data.

*Transmit UPC-A Check Digit
(01h)

Do Not Transmit UPC-A Check Digit
(00h)

Transmit UPC-E Check Digit
Parameter # 29h
The check digit is the last character of the symbol used to verify the integrity of the data. Scan the appropriate bar code below to
transmit the bar code data with or without the UPC-E check digit. It is always verified to guarantee the integrity of the data.

*Transmit UPC-E Check Digit
(01h)

Do Not Transmit UPC-E Check Digit
(00h)

13-16 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit
Parameter # 2Ah
The check digit is the last character of the symbol used to verify the integrity of the data. Scan the appropriate bar code below to
transmit the bar code data with or without the UPC-E1 check digit. It is always verified to guarantee the integrity of the data.

*Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit
(01h)

Do Not Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit
(00h)

UPC-A Preamble
Parameter # 22h
Preamble characters are part of the UPC symbol, and include Country Code and System Character. There are three options for
transmitting a UPC-A preamble to the host device: transmit System Character only, transmit System Character and Country Code (“0”
for USA), and transmit no preamble. Select the appropriate option to match the host system.

No Preamble ()
(00h)

*System Character ( )
(01h)

System Character & Country Code
(< COUNTRY CODE>  )
(02h)

Symbologies 13-17

UPC-E Preamble
Parameter # 23h
Preamble characters are part of the UPC symbol, and include Country Code and System Character. There are three options for
transmitting a UPC-E preamble to the host device: transmit System Character only, transmit System Character and Country Code (“0”
for USA), and transmit no preamble. Select the appropriate option to match the host system.

No Preamble ()
(00h)

*System Character ( )
(01h)

System Character & Country Code
(< COUNTRY CODE>  )
(02h)

13-18 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

UPC-E1 Preamble
Parameter # 24h
Preamble characters are part of the UPC symbol, and include Country Code and System Character. There are three options for
transmitting a UPC-E1 preamble to the host device: transmit System Character only, transmit System Character and Country Code (“0”
for USA), and transmit no preamble. Select the appropriate option to match the host system.

No Preamble ()
(00h)

*System Character ( )
(01h)

System Character & Country Code
(< COUNTRY CODE>  )
(02h)

Convert UPC-E to UPC-A
Parameter # 25h
Enable this to convert UPC-E (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC-A format before transmission. After conversion, the data follows
UPC-A format and is affected by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).
When disabled, UPC-E decoded data is transmitted as UPC-E data, without conversion.

Convert UPC-E to UPC-A (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Convert UPC-E to UPC-A (Disable)
(00h)

Symbologies 13-19

Convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A
Parameter # 26h
Enable this to convert UPC-E1 decoded data to UPC-A format before transmission. After conversion, the data follows UPC-A format
and is affected by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).
When disabled, UPC-E1 decoded data is transmitted as UPC-E1 data, without conversion.

Convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A (Disable)
(00h)

EAN-8/JAN-8 Extend
Parameter # 27h
When enabled, this parameter adds five leading zeros to decoded EAN-8 symbols to make them compatible in format to EAN-13
symbols.
When disabled, EAN-8 symbols are transmitted as is.

Enable EAN/JAN Zero Extend
(01h)

*Disable EAN/JAN Zero Extend
(00h)

13-20 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

UCC Coupon Extended Code
Parameter # 55h
When enabled, this parameter decodes UPC-A bar codes starting with digit ‘5’, EAN-13 bar codes starting with digit ‘99’, and UPCA/EAN-128 Coupon Codes. UPCA, EAN-13, and EAN-128 must be enabled to scan all types of Coupon Codes.

Enable UCC Coupon Extended Code
(01h)

*Disable UCC Coupon Extended Code
(00h)

Use the Decode UPC/EAN Supplemental Redundancy parameter to control autodiscrimination of the
EAN128 (right half) of a coupon code.

Note

Code 128
Enable/Disable Code 128
Parameter # 08h
To enable or disable Code 128, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Code 128
(01h)

Disable Code 128
(00h)

Symbologies 13-21

Enable/Disable UCC/EAN-128
Parameter # 0Eh
To enable or disable UCC/EAN-128, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable UCC/EAN-128
(01h)

Disable UCC/EAN-128
(00h)

Enable/Disable ISBT 128
Parameter # 54h
ISBT 128 is a variant of Code 128 used in the blood bank industry. Scan a bar code below to enable or disable ISBT 128. If necessary,
the host must perform concatenation of the ISBT data.

*Enable ISBT 128
(01h)

Disable ISBT 128
(00h)

13-22 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code 39
Enable/Disable Code 39
Parameter # 00h
To enable or disable Code 39, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Code 39
(01h)

Disable Code 39
(00h)

Enable/Disable Trioptic Code 39
Parameter # 0Dh
Trioptic Code 39 is a variant of Code 39 used in the marking of computer tape cartridges. Trioptic Code 39 symbols always contain six
characters. To enable or disable Trioptic Code 39, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Trioptic Code 39
(01h)

*Disable Trioptic Code 39
(00h)

Trioptic Code 39 and Code 39 Full ASCII cannot be enabled simultaneously.

Note

Symbologies 13-23

Convert Code 39 to Code 32
Parameter # 56h
Code 32 is a variant of Code 39 used by the Italian pharmaceutical industry. Scan the appropriate bar code below to enable or disable
converting Code 39 to Code 32.
Code 39 must be enabled for this parameter to function.

Note

Enable Convert Code 39 to Code 32
(01h)

*Disable Convert Code 39 to Code 32
(00h)

Code 32 Prefix
Parameter # E7h
Scan the appropriate bar code below to enable or disable adding the prefix character “A” to all Code 32 bar codes.
Convert Code 39 to Code 32 must be enabled for this parameter to function.

Note

Enable Code 32 Prefix
(01h)

*Disable Code 32 Prefix
(00h)

13-24 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Set Lengths for Code 39
Parameter # L1 = 12h, L2 = 13h
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for Code 39 to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range. If Code 39 Full ASCII is enabled,
Length Within a Range or Any Length are the preferred options.
When setting lengths for different bar code types by scanning single digit numbers, single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero.

Note
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only Code 39 symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only Code 39 symbols with 14
characters, scan Code 39 - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or change the selection,
scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only Code 39 symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only those Code 39
symbols containing either 2 or 14 characters, select Code 39 - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4.
To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a Code 39 symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode Code 39 symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan Code 39 - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Select this option to decode Code 39 symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Code 39 - One Discrete Length

Code 39 - Two Discrete Lengths

Symbologies 13-25

Set Lengths for Code 39 (continued)

Code 39 - Length Within Range

Code 39 - Any Length

Code 39 Check Digit Verification
Parameter # 30h
When this feature is enabled, the digital scanner checks the integrity of all Code 39 symbols to verify that the data complies with
specified check digit algorithm. Only Code 39 symbols which include a modulo 43 check digit are decoded. Enable this feature if the
Code 39 symbols contain a Modulo 43 check digit.

Enable Code 39 Check Digit
(01h)

*Disable Code 39 Check Digit
(00h)

13-26 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Transmit Code 39 Check Digit
Parameter # 2Bh
Scan a bar code below to transmit Code 39 data with or without the check digit.

Transmit Code 39 Check Digit (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Transmit Code 39 Check Digit (Disable)
(00h)

Code 39 Check Digit Verification must be enabled for this parameter to function.

Note

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion
Parameter # 11h
Code 39 Full ASCII is a variant of Code 39 which pairs characters to encode the full ASCII character set. To enable or disable Code 39
Full ASCII, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Code 39 Full ASCII
(01h)

*Disable Code 39 Full ASCII
(00h)

Trioptic Code 39 and Code 39 Full ASCII cannot be enabled simultaneously.

Note

Code 39 Full ASCII to Full ASCII Correlation is host-dependent, and is therefore described in the ASCII
Character Set Table for the appropriate interface. See the ASCII Character Set for Keyboard Wedge on page
6-15, the ASCII Character Set for USB on page 8-12, or the ASCII Character Set for RS-232 on page 7-21.

Symbologies 13-27

Code 39 Buffering (Scan & Store)
Parameter # 71h
This feature allows the digital scanner to accumulate data from multiple Code 39 symbols.
Selecting the Scan and Store option (Buffer Code 39) temporarily buffers all Code 39 symbols having a leading space as a first
character for later transmission. The leading space is not buffered.
Decode of a valid Code 39 symbol with no leading space causes transmission in sequence of all buffered data in a first-in first-out
format, plus transmission of the “triggering” symbol. See the following pages for further details.
When the Do Not Buffer Code 39 option is selected, all decoded Code 39 symbols are transmitted immediately without being
stored in the buffer.
This feature affects Code 39 only. If selecting Buffer Code 39, we recommend configuring the digital scanner to decode Code 39
symbology only.

Buffer Code 39 (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Buffer Code 39 (Disable)
(00h)

While there is data in the transmission buffer, selecting Do Not Buffer Code 39 is not allowed. The buffer holds 200 bytes of
information.
To disable Code 39 buffering when there is data in the transmission buffer, first force the buffer transmission (see Transmit Buffer on
page 13-28) or clear the buffer.

Buffer Data
To buffer data, Code 39 buffering must be enabled and a Code 39 symbol must be read with a space immediately following the start
pattern.
•
•
•

Unless the data overflows the transmission buffer, the digital scanner issues a lo/hi beep to indicate successful decode and
buffering. (For overflow conditions, see Overfilling Transmission Buffer.)
The digital scanner adds the decoded data excluding the leading space to the transmission buffer.
No transmission occurs.

13-28 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Clear Transmission Buffer
To clear the transmission buffer, scan the Clear Buffer bar code below, which contains only a start character, a dash (minus), and a
stop character.
•
•
•

The digital scanner issues a short hi/lo/hi beep.
The digital scanner erases the transmission buffer.
No transmission occurs.

Clear Buffer

The Clear Buffer contains only the dash (minus) character. In order to scan this command, be sure Code 39
length is set to include length 1.

Note
Transmit Buffer
There are two methods to transmit the Code 39 buffer.
1. Scan the Transmit Buffer bar code below. Only a start character, a plus (+), and a stop character.
• The digital scanner transmits and clears the buffer.
• The digital scanner issues a Lo/Hi beep.

Transmit Buffer

2. Scan a Code 39 bar code with a leading character other than a space.
• The digital scanner appends new decode data to buffered data.
• The digital scanner transmits and clears the buffer.
• The digital scanner signals that the buffer was transmitted with a lo/hi beep.
• The digital scanner transmits and clears the buffer.
The Transmit Buffer contains only a plus (+) character. In order to scan this command, be sure Code 39 length
is set to include length 1.

Note

Symbologies 13-29

Overfilling Transmission Buffer
The Code 39 buffer holds 200 characters. If the symbol just read results in an overflow of the transmission buffer:
•
•

The digital scanner indicates that the symbol was rejected by issuing three long, high beeps.
No transmission occurs. The data in the buffer is not affected.

Attempt to Transmit an Empty Buffer
If the symbol just read was the Transmit Buffer symbol and the Code 39 buffer is empty:
•
•
•

A short lo/hi/lo beep signals that the buffer is empty.
No transmission occurs.
The buffer remains empty.

Code 93
Enable/Disable Code 93
Parameter # 09h
To enable or disable Code 93, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Code 93
(01h)

*Disable Code 93
(00h)

13-30 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Set Lengths for Code 93
Parameter # L1 = 1Ah, L2 = 1Bh
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for Code 93 to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only Code 93 symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only Code 93 symbols with 14
characters, scan Code 93 - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the
selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only Code 93 symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only those Code 93
symbols containing either 2 or 14 characters, select Code 93 - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4.
To correct an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a Code 93 symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode Code 93 symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan Code 93 - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode Code 93 symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner’s
capability.

Symbologies 13-31

Set Lengths for Code 93 (continued)

Code 93 - One Discrete Length

Code 93 - Two Discrete Lengths

Code 93 - Length Within Range

Code 93 - Any Length

Code 11
Code 11
Parameter # 0Ah
To enable or disable Code 11, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Code 11
(01h)

*Disable Code 11
(00h)

13-32 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Set Lengths for Code 11
Parameter # L1 = 1Ch, L2 = 1Dh
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for Code 11 to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only Code 11 symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only Code 11 symbols with 14
characters, scan Code 11 - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the
selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only Code 11 symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only those Code 11
symbols containing either 2 or 14 characters, select Code 11 - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4.
To correct an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a Code 11 symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode Code 11 symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan Code 11 - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode Code 11 symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Code 11 - One Discrete Length

Code 11 - Two Discrete Lengths

Code 11 - Length Within Range

Code 11 - Any Length

Symbologies 13-33

Code 11 Check Digit Verification
Parameter # 34h
This feature allows the digital scanner to check the integrity of all Code 11 symbols to verify that the data complies with the specified
check digit algorithm. This selects the check digit mechanism for the decoded Code 11 bar code. The options are to check for one
check digit, check for two check digits, or disable the feature.
To enable this feature, scan the bar code below corresponding to the number of check digits encoded in the Code 11 symbols.

*Disable
(00h)

One Check Digit
(01h)

Two Check Digits
(02h)

13-34 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Transmit Code 11 Check Digits
Parameter # 2Fh
This feature selects whether or not to transmit the Code 11 check digit(s).

Transmit Code 11 Check Digit(s) (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Transmit Code 11 Check Digit(s) (Disable)
(00h)

Code 11 Check Digit Verification must be enabled for this parameter to function.

Note

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF)
Enable/Disable Interleaved 2 of 5
Parameter # 06h
To enable or disable Interleaved 2 of 5, scan the appropriate bar code below, and select an Interleaved 2 of 5 length from the following
pages.

*Enable Interleaved 2 of 5
(01h)

Disable Interleaved 2 of 5
(00h)

Symbologies 13-35

Set Lengths for Interleaved 2 of 5
Parameter # L1 = 16h, L2 = 17h
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for I 2 of 5 to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only I 2 of 5 symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only I 2 of 5 symbols with 14
characters, scan I 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the
selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only I 2 of 5 symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only those I 2 of 5
symbols containing either 2 or 14 characters, select I 2 of 5 - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4. To
correct an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode an I 2 of 5 symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode I 2 of 5 symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan I 2 of 5 - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers must
always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode I 2 of 5 symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Note

Due to the construction of the I 2 of 5 symbology, it is possible for a scan line covering only a portion of the code to be
interpreted as a complete scan, yielding less data than is encoded in the bar code. To prevent this, select specific
lengths (I 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length - Two Discrete Lengths) for I 2 of 5 applications.

I 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length

I 2 of 5 - Two Discrete Lengths

13-36 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Set Lengths for Interleaved 2 of 5 (continued)

I 2 of 5 - Length Within Range

I 2 of 5 - Any Length

I 2 of 5 Check Digit Verification
Parameter # 31h
When this feature is enabled, the digital scanner checks the integrity of all I 2 of 5 symbols to verify the data complies with either
the specified Uniform Symbology Specification (USS), or the Optical Product Code Council (OPCC) check digit algorithm.

*Disable
(00h)

USS Check Digit
(01h)

OPCC Check Digit
(02h)

Symbologies 13-37

Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit
Parameter # 2Ch
Scan the appropriate bar code below to transmit I 2 of 5 data with or without the check digit.

Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit (Disable)
(00h)

Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN-13
Parameter # 52h
Enable this parameter to convert 14-character I 2 of 5 codes to EAN-13, and transmit to the host as EAN-13. To accomplish this, the
I 2 of 5 code must be enabled, and the code must have a leading zero and a valid EAN-13 check digit.

Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN-13 (Enable)
(01h)

*Do Not Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN-13 (Disable)
(00h)

13-38 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Discrete 2 of 5 (DTF)
Enable/Disable Discrete 2 of 5
Parameter # 05h
To enable or disable Discrete 2 of 5, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Discrete 2 of 5
(01h)

*Disable Discrete 2 of 5
(00h)

Set Lengths for Discrete 2 of 5
Parameter # L1 = 14h, L2 = 15h
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for D 2 of 5 to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only D 2 of 5 symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only D 2 of 5 symbols with 14
characters, scan D 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the
selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only D 2 of 5 symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only those D 2 of 5
symbols containing either 2 or 14 characters, select D 2 of 5 - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4.
To correct an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a D 2 of 5 symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode D 2 of 5 symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan D 2 of 5 - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode D 2 of 5 symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Note

Due to the construction of the D 2 of 5 symbology, it is possible for a scan line covering only a portion of the
code to be interpreted as a complete scan, yielding less data than is encoded in the bar code. To prevent
this, select specific lengths (D 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length - Two Discrete Lengths) for D 2 of 5
applications.

Symbologies 13-39

Set Lengths for Discrete 2 of 5 (continued)

D 2 of 5 - One Discrete Length

D 2 of 5 - Two Discrete Lengths

D 2 of 5 - Length Within Range

D 2 of 5 - Any Length

Codabar (NW - 7)
Enable/Disable Codabar
Parameter # 07h
To enable or disable Codabar, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable Codabar
(01h)

*Disable Codabar
(00h)

13-40 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Set Lengths for Codabar
Parameter # L1 = 18h, L2 = 19h
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for Codabar to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only Codabar symbols containing a selected length. Select the length
using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only Codabar symbols with 14
characters, scan Codabar - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the
selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only Codabar symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only Codabar symbols
containing either 2 or 14 characters, select Codabar - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4. To correct
an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a Codabar symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths
using numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode Codabar symbols containing
between 4 and 12 characters, first scan Codabar - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers
must always be preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode Codabar symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Codabar - One Discrete Length

Codabar - Two Discrete Lengths

Codabar - Length Within Range

Codabar - Any Length

Symbologies 13-41

CLSI Editing
Parameter # 36h
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters and inserts a space after the first, fifth, and tenth characters of a
14-character Codabar symbol. Enable this feature if the host system requires this data format.
Symbol length does not include start and stop characters.

Note

Enable CLSI Editing
(01h)

*Disable CLSI Editing
(00h)

NOTIS Editing
Parameter # 37h
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters from a decoded Codabar symbol. Enable this feature if the host
system requires this data format.

Enable NOTIS Editing
(01h)

*Disable NOTIS Editing
(00h)

13-42 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

MSI
Enable/Disable MSI
Parameter # 0Bh
To enable or disable MSI, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable MSI
(01h)

*Disable MSI
(00h)

Set Lengths for MSI
Parameter # L1 = 1Eh, L2 = 1Fh
The length of a code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s) the code contains.
Set lengths for MSI to any length, one or two discrete lengths, or lengths within a specific range.
•

•

•

•

One Discrete Length - Select this option to decode only MSI symbols containing a selected length. Select the length using
the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only MSI symbols with 14 characters, scan
MSI - One Discrete Length, then scan 1 followed by 4. To correct an error or to change the selection, scan Cancel
on page D-4.
Two Discrete Lengths - Select this option to decode only MSI symbols containing either of two selected lengths.
Select lengths using the numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode only MSI symbols
containing either 2 or 14 characters, select MSI - Two Discrete Lengths, then scan 0, 2, 1, and then 4. To correct an
error or to change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Length Within Range - Select this option to decode a MSI symbol with a specific length range. Select lengths using
numeric bar codes in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. For example, to decode MSI symbols containing between 4 and
12 characters, first scan MSI - Length Within Range. Then scan 0, 4, 1, and 2 (single digit numbers must always be
preceded by a leading zero). To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
Any Length - Scan this option to decode MSI symbols containing any number of characters within the digital scanner
capability.

Note

Due to the construction of the MSI symbology, it is possible for a scan line covering only a portion of the
code to be interpreted as a complete scan, yielding less data than is encoded in the bar code. To prevent
this, select specific lengths (MSI - One Discrete Length - Two Discrete Lengths) for MSI applications.

Symbologies 13-43

Set Lengths for MSI (continued)

MSI - One Discrete Length

MSI - Two Discrete Lengths

MSI - Length Within Range

MSI - Any Length

MSI Check Digits
Parameter # 32h
With MSI symbols, one check digit is mandatory and always verified by the reader. The second check digit is optional. If the MSI
codes include two check digits, scan the Two MSI Check Digits bar code to enable verification of the second check digit.
See MSI Check Digit Algorithm on page 13-44 for the selection of second digit algorithms.

*One MSI Check Digit
(00h)

Two MSI Check Digits
(01h)

13-44 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Transmit MSI Check Digit(s)
Parameter # 2Eh
Scan a bar code below to transmit MSI data with or without the check digit.

Transmit MSI Check Digit(s) (Enable)
(01h

*Do Not Transmit MSI Check Digit(s) (Disable)
(00h)

MSI Check Digit Algorithm
Parameter # 33h
Two algorithms are possible for the verification of the second MSI check digit. Select the bar code below corresponding to the
algorithm used to encode the check digit.

MOD 10/MOD 11
(00h)

*MOD 10/MOD 10
(01h)

Symbologies 13-45

Postal Codes
US Postnet
Parameter # 59h
To enable or disable US Postnet, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable US Postnet
(01h)

Disable US Postnet
(00h)

US Planet
Parameter # 5Ah
To enable or disable US Planet, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable US Planet
(01h)

Disable US Planet
(00h)

13-46 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

UK Postal
Parameter # 5Bh
To enable or disable UK Postal, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable UK Postal
(01h)

Disable UK Postal
(00h)

Transmit UK Postal Check Digit
Parameter # 60h
Select whether to transmit UK Postal data with or without the check digit.

*Transmit UK Postal
Check Digit
(01h)

Do Not Transmit UK Postal Check Digit
(00h)

Symbologies 13-47

Japan Postal
Parameter # F0h, 22h
To enable or disable Japan Postal, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Japan Postal
(01h)

Disable Japan Postal
(00h)

Australian Postal
Parameter # F0h, 23h
To enable or disable Australian Postal, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Australian Postal
(01h)

Disable Australian Postal
(00h)

13-48 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Dutch Postal
Parameter # F0h, 46h
To enable or disable Dutch Postal, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Dutch Postal
(01h)

Disable Dutch Postal
(00h)

Transmit US Postal Check Digit
Parameter # 5Fh
Select whether to transmit US Postal data with or without the check digit.

*Transmit US Postal Check Digit
(01h)

Do Not Transmit US Postal Check Digit
(00h)

Symbologies 13-49

RSS (Reduced Space Symbology)
The variants of RSS are RSS 14, RSS Expanded, and RSS Limited. The limited and expanded versions have stacked variants. Scan the
appropriate bar code below to enable or disable each variant of RSS.

RSS-14
Parameter # F0h 52h.

*Enable RSS 14
(01h)

Disable RSS 14
(00h)

RSS Limited
Parameter # F0h 53h.

*Enable RSS Limited
(01h)

Disable RSS Limited
(00h)

13-50 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

RSS Expanded
Parameter # F0h 54h.

*Enable RSS Expanded
(01h)

Disable RSS Expanded
(00h)

Convert RSS to UPC/EAN
Parameter # F0h, 8Dh
This parameter only applies to RSS-14 and RSS Limited symbols not decoded as part of a Composite symbol. Enable this to strip the
leading '010' from RSS-14 and RSS Limited symbols encoding a single zero as the first digit, and report the bar code as EAN-13.
For bar codes beginning with two or more zeros but not six zeros, this parameter strips the leading '0100' and reports the bar code as
UPC-A. The UPC-A Preamble parameter that transmits the system character and country code applies to converted bar codes. Note
that neither the system character nor the check digit can be stripped.

Enable Convert RSS to UPC/EAN
(01h)

*Disable Convert RSS to UPC/EAN
(00h)

Symbologies 13-51

Composite
Composite CC-C
Parameter # F0h 55h
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Composite bar codes of type CC-C.

Enable CC-C
(01h)

*Disable CC-C
(00h)

Composite CC-A/B
Parameter # F0h 56h
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Composite bar codes of type CC-A/B.

Enable CC-A/B
(01h)

*Disable CC-A/B
(00h)

13-52 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Composite TLC-39
Parameter # F0h 73h
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Composite bar codes of type TLC-39.

Enable TLC39
(01h)

*Disable TLC39
(00h)

Symbologies 13-53

UPC Composite Mode
Parameter # F0h 58h
UPC symbols can be “linked” with a 2D symbol during transmission as if they were one symbol. There are three options for these
symbols:
•
•
•

Select UPC Never Linked to transmit UPC bar codes regardless of whether a 2D symbol is detected.
Select UPC Always Linked to transmit UPC bar codes and the 2D portion.
If 2D is not present, the UPC bar code does not transmit.
If Autodiscriminate UPC Composites is selected, the scanner determines if there is a 2D portion, then transmits the UPC, as
well as the 2D portion if present.

UPC Never Linked
(00h)

*UPC Always Linked
(01h)

Autodiscriminate UPC Composites
(02h)

13-54 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Composite Beep Mode
Parameter # F0h, 8Eh
To select the number of decode beeps when a composite bar code is decoded, scan the appropriate bar code.

Single Beep after both are decoded
(00h)

*Beep as each code type is decoded
(01h)

Double Beep after both are decoded
(02h)

UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for UCC/EAN Composite Codes
Parameter # F0h, ABh
Select whether to enable or disable this mode.

Enable UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for
UCC/EAN Composite Codes
(01h)

*Disable UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for
UCC/EAN Composite Codes
(00h)

Symbologies 13-55

2D Symbologies
Enable/Disable PDF417
Parameter # 0Fh
To enable or disable PDF417, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable PDF417
(01h)

Disable PDF417
(00h)

Enable/Disable MicroPDF417
Parameter # E3h
To enable or disable MicroPDF417, scan the appropriate bar code below.

Enable MicroPDF417
(01h)

*Disable MicroPDF417
(00h)

13-56 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code 128 Emulation
Parameter # 7Bh
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from certain MicroPDF417 symbols as if it was encoded in Code 128
symbols. Transmit AIM Symbology Identifiers must be enabled for this parameter to work.
If Code 128 Emulation is enabled, these MicroPDF417 symbols are transmitted with one of the following prefixes:
]C1

if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915

]C2

if the first codeword is 908 or 909

]C0

if the first codeword is 910 or 911

If disabled, they are transmitted with one of the following prefixes:
]L3

if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915

]L4

if the first codeword is 908 or 909

]L5

if the first codeword is 910 or 911

Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Code 128 Emulation.

Enable Code 128 Emulation
(01h)

*Disable Code 128 Emulation
(00h)

Symbologies 13-57

Data Matrix
Parameter # F0h, 24h
To enable or disable Data Matrix, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Data Matrix
(01h)

Disable Data Matrix
(00h)

Maxicode
Parameter # F0h, 26h
To enable or disable Maxicode, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable Maxicode
(01h)

Disable Maxicode
(00h)

13-58 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

QR Code
Parameter # F0h,25h
To enable or disable QR Code, scan the appropriate bar code below.

*Enable QR Code
(01h)

Disable QR Code
(00h)

Symbologies 13-59

Redundancy Level
Parameter # 4Eh
The digital scanner offers four levels of decode redundancy. Select higher redundancy levels for decreasing levels of bar code quality.
As redundancy levels increase, the digital scanner’s aggressiveness decreases.
Select the redundancy level appropriate for the bar code quality.

Redundancy Level 1
The following code types must be successfully read twice before being decoded:
Code Type

Code Length

Codabar

8 characters or less

MSI

4 characters or less

D 2 of 5

8 characters or less

I 2 of 5

8 characters or less

Redundancy Level 2
The following code types must be successfully read twice before being decoded:
Code Type
All

Code Length
All

Redundancy Level 3
Code types other than the following must be successfully read twice before being decoded. The following codes must be read three
times:
Code Type

Code Length

MSI Plessey

4 characters or less

D 2 of 5

8 characters or less

I 2 of 5

8 characters or less

Codabar

8 characters or less

Redundancy Level 4
The following code types must be successfully read three times before being decoded:
Code Type
All

Code Length
All

13-60 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Redundancy Level (continued)

*Redundancy Level 1
(01h)

Redundancy Level 2
(02h)

Redundancy Level 3
(03h)

Redundancy Level 4
(04h)

Symbologies 13-61

Security Level
Parameter # 4Dh
The digital scanner offers four levels of decode security for delta bar codes, which include the Code 128 family, UPC/EAN, and Code
93. Select increasing levels of security for decreasing levels of bar code quality. There is an inverse relationship between security and
digital scanner aggressiveness, so choose only that level of security necessary for any given application.
•
•
•
•

Security Level 0: This default setting allows the digital scanner to operate in its most aggressive state, while providing
sufficient security in decoding most “in-spec” bar codes.
Security Level 1: Select this option if misdecodes occur. This security level should eliminate most misdecodes.
Security Level 2: Select this option if Security level 1 fails to eliminate misdecodes.
Security Level 3: If Security Level 2 was selected and misdecodes still occur, select this security level. Be advised, selecting
this option is an extreme measure against mis-decoding severely out of spec bar codes. Selecting this level of security
significantly impairs the decoding ability of the digital scanner. If this level of security is necessary, try to improve the quality
of the bar codes.

*Security Level 0
(00h)

Security Level 1
(01h)

Security Level 2
(02h)

Security Level 3
(03h)

13-62 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Intercharacter Gap Size
Parameter # F0h, 7Dh
The Code 39 and Codabar symbologies have an intercharacter gap that is typically quite small. Due to various bar code-printing
technologies, this gap can grow larger than the maximum size allowed, preventing the digital scanner from decoding the symbol. If
this problem occurs, scan the Large Intercharacter Gaps parameter to tolerate these out-of-specification bar codes.

*Normal Intercharacter Gaps
(06h)

Large Intercharacter Gaps
(0Ah)

Report Version
Scan the bar code below to report the version of software currently installed in the digital scanner.

Report Software Version

Symbologies 13-63

Macro PDF Features
Macro PDF is a special feature for concatenating multiple PDF symbols into one file. The digital scanner can decode symbols that are
encoded with this feature, and can store more than 64 kb of decoded data stored in up to 50 MacroPDF symbols.

CAUTION

When printing, keep each Macro PDF sequence separate, as each sequence has unique identifiers. Do not
mix bar codes from several Macro PDF sequences, even if they encode the same data. When scanning Macro
PDF sequences, scan the entire Macro PDF sequence without interruption. If, when scanning a mixed
sequence, the digital scanner emits two long low beeps (Lo Lo) this indicates an inconsistent file ID or
inconsistent symbology error.

Flush Macro Buffer
This flushes the buffer of all decoded Macro PDF data stored to that point, transmits it to the host device, and aborts from Macro PDF
mode.

Flush Macro PDF Buffer

Abort Macro PDF Entry
This clears all currently-stored Macro PDF data in the buffer without transmission and aborts from Macro PDF mode.

Abort Macro PDF Entry

13-64 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Miscellaneous Scanner Options
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3
Scanning Sequence Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3
Errors While Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3
Miscellaneous Scanner Parameter Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-4
Miscellaneous Scanner Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5
Transmit Code ID Character . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5
Prefix/Suffix Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-6
Scan Data Transmission Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-7
FN1 Substitution Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-8
Transmit “No Read” Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-9
Synapse Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-10

14-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Miscellaneous Scanner Options 14-3

Introduction
This chapter includes commonly used bar codes to customize how data is transmitted to the host device. See Chapter 15, Advanced
Data Formatting for further customization options.
The digital scanner ships with the settings shown in the Miscellaneous Scanner Options Default Table on page 14-4 (also see
Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all host device and miscellaneous scanner defaults). If the default values suit
requirements, programming is not necessary.
To set feature values, scan a single bar code or a short bar code sequence. The settings are stored in non-volatile memory and are
preserved even when the digital scanner is powered down.

Note

Most computer monitors allow scanning the bar codes directly on the screen. When scanning from the screen, be sure
to set the document magnification to a level where the bar code can be seen clearly, and bars and/or spaces are not
merging.

If not using a Synapse or USB cable, select a host type (see each host chapter for specific host information) after the power-up beeps
sound. This is only necessary upon the first power-up when connected to a new host.
To return all features to default values, scan the *Set All Defaults bar code on page 4-5. Throughout the programming bar code menus,
default values are indicated with asterisks (*).

* Indicates Default

*Disable No Read

Feature/Option

(00h)
Hex Value

Scanning Sequence Examples
In most cases, scan one bar code to set a specific parameter value. Other parameters, such as Prefix Value, require scanning several
bar codes. See each parameter for descriptions of this procedure.

Errors While Scanning
Unless otherwise specified, to correct an error during a scanning sequence, just re-scan the correct parameter.

14-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Miscellaneous Scanner Parameter Defaults
Table 14-1 lists the defaults for miscellaneous scanner options parameters. To change any option, scan the appropriate bar code(s)
provided in the Miscellaneous Scanner Parameters on page 14-5.
See Appendix A, Standard Default Parameters for all user preferences, hosts, symbologies, and
miscellaneous default parameters.

Note
Table 14-1. Miscellaneous Scanner Options Default Table
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Transmit Code ID Character

2Dh

None

14-5

Prefix Value

63h, 69h

7013 

14-6

Suffix 1 Value
Suffix 2 Value

62h, 68h
64h, 6Ah

7013 

14-6

Scan Data Transmission Format

EBh

Data as is

14-7

FN1 Substitution Values

67h, 6Dh

Set

14-8

Transmit “No Read” Message

5Eh

Disable

14-9

Synapse Interface

F0h ACh

Standard

14-10

Miscellaneous Scanner Options 14-5

Miscellaneous Scanner Parameters
Transmit Code ID Character
Parameter # 2Dh
A Code ID character identifies the code type of a scanned bar code. This is useful when the digital scanner is decoding more than one
code type. In addition to any single character prefix already selected, the Code ID character is inserted between the prefix and the
decoded symbol.
Select no Code ID character, a Symbol Code ID character, or an AIM Code ID character. For Code ID Characters, see Symbol Code
Identifiers on page B-3 and AIM Code Identifiers on page B-4.

Symbol Code ID Character
(02h)

AIM Code ID Character
(01h)

*None
(00h)

14-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Prefix/Suffix Values
Key Category Parameter # P = 63h, S1 = 62h, S2 = 64h
Decimal Value Parameter # P = 69h, S1 = 68h, S2 = 6Ah
A prefix and/or one or two suffixes can be appended to scan data for use in data editing. To set a value for a prefix or suffix, scan a
four-digit number (i.e., four bar codes from Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes) that corresponds to that value. See Table E-1 on page E3 for the four-digit codes.
When using host commands to set the prefix or suffix , set the key category parameter to 1, then set the 3-digit decimal value. See
Table E-1 on page E-3 for the four-digit codes.
To correct an error or change a selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.
To use Prefix/Suffix values, first set the Scan Data Transmission Format on page 14-7.

Note

Scan Prefix
(07h)

Scan Suffix 1
(06h)

Scan Suffix 2
(08h)

Data Format Cancel

Miscellaneous Scanner Options 14-7

Scan Data Transmission Format
Parameter # EBh
To change the scan data format, scan one of the following eight bar codes corresponding to the desired format.
If using this parameter do not use ADF rules to set the prefix/suffix.

Note

To set values for the prefix and/or suffix, see Prefix/Suffix Values on page 14-6.

*Data As Is
(00h)

 
(01h)

 
(02h)

  
(03h)

 
(04h)

14-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scan Data Transmission Format (continued)

  
(05h)

  
(06h)

   
(07h)

FN1 Substitution Values
Key Category Parameter # 67h
Decimal Value Parameter # 6Dh
The Wedge and USB HID Keyboard hosts support a FN1 Substitution feature. When enabled any FN1 character (0x1b) in an EAN128
bar code is substituted with a value. This value defaults to 7013 (Enter Key).
When using host commands to set the FN1 substitution value, set the key category parameter to 1, then set the 3-digit keystroke
value. See the ASCII Character Set table for the currently installed host interface for the desired value.
To select a FN1 substitution value via bar code menus:
1. Scan the bar code below.

Set FN1 Substitution Value

2. Look up the keystroke desired for FN1 Substitution in the ASCII Character Set table for the currently installed host interface.
Enter the 4-digit ASCII Value by scanning each digit in Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes.
To correct an error or change the selection, scan Cancel.
To enable FN1 substitution for keyboard wedge, scan the Enable FN1 Substitution bar code on page 6-12.
To enable FN1 substitution for USB HID keyboard, scan the Enable FN1 Substitution bar code on page 8-10.

Miscellaneous Scanner Options 14-9

Transmit “No Read” Message
Parameter # 5Eh
Scan a bar code below to select whether or not to transmit a No Read message. When enabled, the characters NR are transmitted
when a bar code is not decoded. When disabled, if a symbol does not decode, nothing is sent to the host.

Enable No Read
(01h)

*Disable No Read
(00h)

14-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Synapse Interface
Parameter # F0h, ACh
The auto-detection of a Synapse cable varies in duration depending on the type of Synapse connection. If a digital scanner is
connected to another scanner using a Synapse cable, use the Auxiliary Synapse Port connection. In all other cases, where the cable
is used, the default setting is recommended.
To disconnect and reconnect the digital scanner from a Synapse cable that is connected to a live host via a Synapse, use the "Plug
and Play" setting. Do not change this setting from the default if an on-board wedge host is enabled.

*Standard Synapse Connection
(01h)

Auxiliary Synapse Port Connection
(32h)

“Plug and Play” Synapse Connection
(0Ah)

Advanced Data Formatting
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
Rules: Criteria Linked to Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-3
Using ADF Bar Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
ADF Bar Code Menu Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
Rule 1: The Code 128 Scanning Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5
Rule 2: The UPC Scanning Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5
Alternate Rule Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5
Rules Hierarchy (in Bar Codes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-6
Default Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
Special Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
Pause Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
Begin New Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
Save Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
Erase. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
Quit Entering Rules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
Disable Rule Set. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-10
Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-11
Code Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-11
Code Lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-17
Message Containing A Specific Data String . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-22
Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-27
Send Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-27
Setup Field(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-30
Modify Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-36
Pad Data with Spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-37
Pad Data with Zeros. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-41

15-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Beeps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
Send Keystroke (Control Characters and Keyboard Characters) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
Send Right Control Key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-82
Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-83
Turn On/Off Rule Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-88
Alphanumeric Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-90

Advanced Data Formatting 15-3

Introduction
Advanced Data Formatting (ADF) is a means of customizing data before transmission to the host device. Scan data can be edited to
suit particular requirements.
ADF can be implemented through scanning a related series of bar codes, which begin on page 15-8, or by installing the 123Scan utility
(see Chapter 12, 123 Scan) which allows the digital scanner to be setup and programmed with Advanced Data Formatting (ADF) Rules.
Avoid using ADF formatting with bar codes containing more than 60 characters. To add a prefix or suffix value for such bar codes, use
Add Prefix/Suffix setting. Using ADF with longer bar codes transmits the bar code in segments of length 252 or less (depending on
the host selected), and applies the rule to each segment
If using the Wand interface with the digital scanner, in order to use ADF rules to format data, first enable
Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39 on page 10-8.

Note

Rules: Criteria Linked to Actions
In ADF, data is customized through rules. These rules perform detailed actions when the data meets certain criteria. One rule may
consist of single or multiple criteria applied to single or multiple actions.
For instance, a data formatting rule could be the following:
Criteria:

When scan data is Code 39, length 12, and data at the start position is
the string “129”,

Actions:

pad all sends with zeros to length 8,
send all data up to X,
send a space.

If a Code 39 bar code of 1299X1559828 is scanned, the following is transmitted: 00001299. If a Code 39 bar code of
1299X15598 is scanned, this rule is ignored because the length criteria has not been met.
The rule specifies the editing conditions and requirements before data transmission occurs.

15-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Using ADF Bar Codes
When programming a rule, make sure the rule is logically correct. Plan ahead before scanning.
To program each data formatting rule:
•
•

Start the Rule. Scan the Begin New Rule bar code on page 15-8.
Criteria. Scan the bar codes for all pertinent criteria. Criteria can include code type (e.g., Code 128), code length, or data
that contains a specific character string (e.g., the digits “129”). These options are described in Criteria on page 15-11.
• Actions. Scan all actions related to, or affecting, these criteria. The actions of a rule specify how to format the data for
transmission. These options are described in ADF Bar Code Menu Example on page 15-4.
• Save the Rule. Scan the Save Rule bar code on page 15-8. This places the rule in the “top” position in the rule buffer.
• Some special-purpose bar codes can be useful to correct errors during this process:
Erase Criteria and Start Again, Erase Actions and Start Again, Erase Previously Saved Rule, etc.
Criteria, actions, and entire rules may be erased by scanning the appropriate bar code (see page 15-9).
Beeper Definitions on page 2-4 guide through the programming steps.

ADF Bar Code Menu Example
This section provides an example of how ADF rules are entered and used for scan data.
An auto parts distribution center wants to encode manufacturer ID, part number, and destination code into their own Code 128 bar
codes. The distribution center also has products that carry UPC bar codes, placed there by the manufacturer. The Code 128 bar codes
have the following format:
MMMMMPPPPPDD
Where:

M = Manufacturer ID
P = Part Number
D = Destination Code

The distribution center uses a PC with dedicated control characters for manufacturer ID , part number , and
destination code . At this center the UPC data is treated as manufacturer ID code.
The following rules need to be entered:
When scanning data of code type Code 128, send the next 5 characters, send the manufacturer ID key , send the next
5 characters, send the part number key , send the next 2 characters, send the destination code key .
When scanning data of code type UPC/EAN, send all data, send the manufacturer ID key .
To enter these rules, follow the steps below:

Advanced Data Formatting 15-5

Rule 1: The Code 128 Scanning Rule
Step

Bar Code

On Page

Beep Indication

1

Begin New Rule

15-8

High High

2

Code 128

15-11

High High

3

Send next 5 characters

15-28

High High

4

Send 

15-48

High High

5

Send next 5 characters

15-28

High High

6

Send 

15-48

High High

7

Send next 2 characters

15-27

High High

8

Send 

15-47

High High

9

Save Rule

15-8

High Low High Low

Rule 2: The UPC Scanning Rule
Step

Bar Code

On Page

Beep Indication

1

Begin New Rule

15-8

High High

2

UPC/EAN

15-12

High High

3

Send all remaining data

15-27

High High

4

Send 

15-48

High High

5

Save Rule

15-8

High Low High Low

To correct any errors made while entering this rule, scan the Quit Entering Rules bar code on page 15-9. If the rule is already saved,
scan the Erase Previously Saved Rule bar code on page 15-9.

Alternate Rule Sets
ADF rules may be grouped into one of four alternate sets which can be turned on and off when needed. This is useful to format the
same message in different ways. For example, a Code 128 bar code contains the following information:
Class (2 digits), Stock Number (8) digits, Price (5 digits)
This bar code might look like this:
245671243701500
where:
Class = 24
Stock Number = 56712437
Price = 01500
Ordinarily, data is sent as follows:
24 (class key)
56712437 (stock key)
01500 (enter key)
But, when there is a sale, send only the following:
24 (class key)
56712437 (stock key)

15-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

and the cashier will key the price manually.
To implement this, first enter an ADF rule that applies to the normal situation, such as:
Scan Rule Belongs to Set 1. When scanning a bar code of length 15, send the next 2 characters, send the class key, send the next
8 characters, send the stock key, send the data that remains, send the Enter key.
The “sale” rule may look like this:
Scan Rule Belongs to Set 2. When scanning a bar code of length 15, send the next 2 characters, send the class key, send the next
8 characters, send the stock key.
To switch between the two sets of rules, a “switching rule” must be programmed. This rule specifies what type of bar code must be
scanned to switch between the rule sets. For example, in the case of the “sale” rule above, the rule programmer wants the cashier
to scan the bar code “M” before a sale. To do this, a rule can be entered as follows:
When scanning a bar code of length 1 that begins with “M”, select rule set number 1.
Another rule could be programmed to switch back.
When scanning a bar code of length 1 that begins with “N”, turn off rule set number 1.
The switching back to normal rules can also be done in the “sale” rule. For example, the rule may look like this:
When scanning a bar code of length 15, send the next 2 characters, send the class key, send the next 8 characters, send the stock
key, turn off rule set 1.
For optimal results, scan the Disable All Rule Sets bar code on page 15-10 after programming a rule belonging to an alternate rule
set.
In addition to enabling and disabling rule sets within the rules, enable or disable them by scanning the appropriate bar codes on 15-10.

Rules Hierarchy (in Bar Codes)
The order of programming individual rules is important.The most general rule should be programmed last.
All programmed rules are stored in a buffer. As they are programmed, they are stored at the “top” of a rules list. If three rules have
been created, the list would be configured as follows:
Third Rule
Second Rule
First Rule
When data is scanned, the rules list is checked from top to bottom to determine if the criteria matches (and therefore, if the actions
should occur). Input is modified into the data format specified by the first matching set of criteria it finds. Be sure to program the most
general rule last.
For example, if the THIRD rule states:
When scanning a bar code of any length, send all data, then send the ENTER key.
And the SECOND rule states:
When scanning a Code 128 bar code of length 12, send the first four characters, then send the ENTER key, then send all remaining
data.
If a Code 128 bar code of length 12 were scanned, the THIRD rule would be in effect. The SECOND rule would appear to not function.
Note also that ADF rules are actually created when using the standard data editing functions. Scan options are entered as ADF rules,
and the hierarchy mentioned above also applies to them. For the digital scanner, this applies to prefix/suffix programming in the
parameter Scan Data Transmission Format.

Advanced Data Formatting 15-7

These rules reside in the same “rule list” as ADF Rules, so the order of their creation is also important.

Default Rules
Every unit has a default rule to send all scan data. Units with custom software may have one or more default rules burned in. The
rules hierarchy checks user programmable rules first, then the default rules. Default rules can be disabled by entering the following
general rule in the user programmable buffer:
When receiving scan data, send all data.
Since this rule always applies, ADF will never go into the default rules.

15-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Special Commands
Pause Duration
This parameter along with the Send Pause parameter on page 15-31 allows a pause to be inserted in the data transmission. Pauses
are set by scanning a two-digit number (i.e., two bar codes), and are measured in 0.1 second intervals. For example, scanning bar
codes “0” and “1” inserts a 0.1 second pause; “0” and “5” inserts a 0.5 second delay. See Appendix D, Numeric Bar Codes. To correct
an error or change a selection, scan Cancel on page D-4.

Pause Duration

Begin New Rule
Scan this bar code to start entering a new rule
.

Begin New Rule

Save Rule
Scan this bar code to save the rule.

Save Rule

Advanced Data Formatting 15-9

Erase
Use these bar codes to erase criteria, actions, or rules.

Erase Criteria And Start Again

Erase Actions And Start Again

Erase Previously Saved Rule

Erase All Rules

Quit Entering Rules
Scan this bar code to quit entering rules.

Quit Entering Rules

15-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Disable Rule Set
Use these bar codes to disable rule sets.

Disable Rule Set 1

Disable Rule Set 2

Disable Rule Set 3

Disable Rule Set 4

Disable All Rule Sets

Advanced Data Formatting 15-11

Criteria
Code Types
Select any number of code types to be affected. All selected codes must be scanned in succession, prior to selecting other criteria.
To select all code types, do not scan any code type.
Scan the bar codes for all code types desired before selecting other criteria.

Code 39

Codabar

RSS 14

RSS Limited

RSS Expanded

Code 128

D 2 OF 5

15-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code Types (continued)

IATA 2 OF 5

I 2 OF 5

Code 93

UPC-A

UPC-E

EAN-8

EAN-13

Advanced Data Formatting 15-13

Code Types (continued)

MSI

UCC/EAN 128

UPC-E1

Bookland EAN

Trioptic Code 39

Code 11

Code 32

15-14 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code Types (continued)

ISBT 128

EAN 128

Coupon Code

US Postnet

US Planet

UK Postal

Japan Postal

Advanced Data Formatting 15-15

Code Types (continued)

Australian Postal

Dutch Postal

PDF417

MicroPDF

Macro PDF

Macro MicroPDF

MaxiCode

15-16 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code Types (continued)

Datamatrix

QR Code

TLC 39

UPC/EAN Composites

RSS and EAN128 Composites

When selecting composite bar codes, enable AIM IDs if parsing UPC or EAN composite data, or data from an
application that uses symbol separators.

Advanced Data Formatting 15-17

Code Lengths
Define the number of characters the selected code type must contain. Do not select any code length to select code types of any length.
Scan these bar codes to define the number of characters the selected code types must contain. Select one length per rule only.

1 Character

2 Characters

3 Characters

4 Characters

5 Characters

6 Characters

15-18 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code Lengths (continued)

7 Characters

8 Characters

9 Characters

10 Characters

11 Characters

12 Characters

13 Characters

Advanced Data Formatting 15-19

Code Lengths (continued)

14 Characters

15 Characters

16 Characters

17 Characters

18 Characters

19 Characters

20 Characters

15-20 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Code Lengths (continued)

21 Characters

22 Characters

23 Characters

24 Characters

25 Characters

26 Characters

27 Characters

Advanced Data Formatting 15-21

Code Lengths (continued)

28 Characters

29 Characters

30 Characters

15-22 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Message Containing A Specific Data String
Use this feature to select whether the formatting affects data that begins with a specific character or data string, or contains a
specific character or data string.
There are 4 features:
•
•
•
•

Specific String at Start
Specific String, Any Location
Any Message OK
Rule Belongs to Set

Specific String at Start
Scan this bar code, then scan the bar codes representing the desired character or characters (up to a total of 8) in the Alphanumeric
Keyboard on page 15-90.
After scanning the following bar code:
1. Enter a string using the Alphanumeric Keyboard beginning on page 15-90.
2. Scan End of Message on page 15-99.

Specific String At Start

Advanced Data Formatting 15-23

Specific String, Any Location
Scan this bar code, then, using the Numeric Keypad on page 15-24, scan a two-digit number representing the position (use a leading
“zero” if necessary). Then scan the desired character or characters (up to a total of 8) on the Alphanumeric Keyboard on page 15-90,
followed by the End of Message bar code on page 15-99.
After scanning the following bar code:
1. Enter a location using the “Numeric Keypad” on page 24.
2. Enter a string using the Alphanumeric Keyboard beginning on page 15-90.
3. Scan End of Message on page 15-99.

Specific String Any Location

Any Message OK
By not scanning any bar code, all selected code types are formatted, regardless of information contained.

15-24 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Numeric Keypad
Bar codes on this page should not be confused with those on the alphanumeric keyboard.

0

1

2

3

4

5

6

Advanced Data Formatting 15-25

Numeric Keypad (continued)

7

8

9

Cancel

15-26 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Rule Belongs To Set
Select the set a rule belongs to. (There are four possible rule sets.) See Alternate Rule Sets on page 15-5 for more information about
rule sets.
Scan a bar code below to select which set a rule belongs to.

Rule Belongs To Set 1

Rule Belongs To Set 2

Rule Belongs To Set 3

Rule Belongs To Set 4

Advanced Data Formatting 15-27

Actions
Select how to format the data for transmission.

Send Data
Send all data that remains, send all data up to a specific character selected from the Alphanumeric Keyboard on page 15-90, or send
the next N characters. N = any number from 1 to 254, selected from the Alphanumeric Keyboard. Use these bar codes to send data.

Send Data Up To Character

Send All Data That Remains

Send Next Character

Send Next 2 Characters

Send Next 3 Characters

Send Next 4 Characters

15-28 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Data (continued)

Send Next 5 Characters

Send Next 6 Characters

Send Next 7 Characters

Send Next 8 Characters

Send Next 9 Characters

Send Next 10 Characters

Send Next 11 Characters

Advanced Data Formatting 15-29

Send Data (continued)

Send Next 12 Characters

Send Next 13 Characters

Send Next 14 Characters

Send Next 15 Characters

Send Next 16 Characters

Send Next 17 Characters

Send Next 18 Characters

15-30 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Data (continued)

Send Next 19 Characters

Send Next 20 Characters

Setup Field(s)
Table 15-1. Setup Field(s) Definitions
Parameter

Description

Page

Move Cursor

Move Cursor To a Character

Scan the Move Cursor To Character bar code on page 15-31, 15-31
then any printable ASCII character from the Alphanumeric
Keyboard. When this is used, the cursor moves to the position
after the matching character. If the character is not there, the rule
fails and ADF tries the next rule.

Move Cursor to Start of Data

Scan this bar code to move cursor to the beginning of the data.

Move Cursor Past a Character

This parameter moves the cursor past all sequential occurrences 15-31
of a selected character. For example, if the selected character is
‘A’, then the cursor moves past ‘A’, ‘AA’, ‘AAA’, etc. Scan the
Move Cursor Past Character bar code on page 15-31, then
select a character from the Alphanumeric Keyboard. If the
character is not there, the cursor does not move (i.e., has no
effect).

Skip Ahead “N” Characters

Scan one of these bar codes to select the number of positions
ahead to move the cursor.

15-32

Skip Back “N” Characters

Scan one of these bar codes to select the number of positions
back to move the cursor.

15-33

Send Preset Value

Send Values 1 through 6 by scanning the appropriate bar code. 15-35
These values must be set using the prefix/suffix values in Table
7-4 on page 7-21.
Value 1 = Scan Suffix
Value 2 = Scan Prefix
Values 3-6 are not applicable

15-31

Advanced Data Formatting 15-31

Move Cursor
Scan a bar code below to move the cursor in relation to a specified character. Then enter a character by scanning a bar code from the
Alphanumeric Keyboard beginning on page 15-90.

If there is no match when the rule is interpreted and the rule fails, the next rule is checked.

Move Cursor To Character

Move Cursor To Start

Move Cursor Past Character

Send Pause
Scan the bar code below to insert a pause in the transmission of data. The length of this pause is controlled by the value of the Pause
Duration parameter.

Send Pause

15-32 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Skip Ahead
Use the following bar codes to skip ahead characters.

Skip Ahead 1 Character

Skip Ahead 2 Characters

Skip Ahead 3 Characters

Skip Ahead 4 Characters

Skip Ahead 5 Characters

Skip Ahead 7 Characters

Skip Ahead 8 Characters

Advanced Data Formatting 15-33

Skip Ahead (continued)

Skip Ahead 9 Characters

Skip Ahead 10 Characters

Skip Ahead 6 Characters

Skip Back
Use the following bar codes to skip back characters.

Skip Back 1 Character

Skip Back 2 Characters

Skip Back 3 Characters

15-34 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Skip Back (continued)

Skip Back 4 Characters

Skip Back 5 Characters

Skip Back 6 Characters

Skip Back 7 Characters

Skip Back 8 Characters

Skip Back 9 Characters

Skip Back 10 Characters

Advanced Data Formatting 15-35

Send Preset Value
Use these bar codes to send preset values. These values must be set using the Scan Prefix and Scan Suffix bar codes on page 14-6.

Send Prefix

Send Suffix

15-36 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Modify Data
Modify data in the ways listed. The following actions work for all send commands that follow it within a rule. Programming pad zeros
to length 6, send next 3 characters, stop padding, send next 5 characters, adds three zeros to the first send, and the next send is
unaffected by the padding. These options do not apply to the Send Keystroke or Send Preset Value options.

Remove All Spaces
To remove all spaces in the send commands that follow, scan this bar code.

Remove All Spaces

Crunch All Spaces
To leave one space between words, scan this bar code. This also removes all leading and trailing spaces.

Crunch All Spaces

Stop Space Removal
Scan this bar code to disable space removal.

Stop Space Removal

Remove Leading Zeros
Scan this bar code to remove all leading zeros.

Remove Leading Zeros

Stop Zero Removal
Scan this bar code to disable the removal of zeros.

Stop Zero Removal

Advanced Data Formatting 15-37

Pad Data with Spaces
To pad data to the left, scan the bar code containing the desired number of spaces. This parameter is activated by Send commands.

Pad Spaces To Length 1

Pad Spaces To Length 2

Pad Spaces To Length 3

Pad Spaces To Length 4

Pad Spaces To Length 5

Pad Spaces To Length 6

Pad Spaces To Length 7

15-38 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Pad Data with Spaces (continued)

Pad Spaces To Length 8

Pad Spaces To Length 9

Pad Spaces To Length 10

Pad Spaces To Length 11

Pad Spaces To Length 12

Pad Spaces To Length 13

Pad Spaces To Length 14

Advanced Data Formatting 15-39

Pad Data with Spaces (continued)

Pad Spaces To Length 15

Pad Spaces To Length 16

Pad Spaces To Length 17

Pad Spaces To Length 18

Pad Spaces To Length 19

Pad Spaces To Length 20

Pad Spaces To Length 21

15-40 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Pad Data with Spaces (continued)

Pad Spaces To Length 22

Pad Spaces To Length 23

Pad Spaces To Length 24

Pad Spaces To Length 25

Pad Spaces To Length 26

Pad Spaces To Length 27

Pad Spaces To Length 28

Advanced Data Formatting 15-41

Pad Data with Spaces (continued)

Pad Spaces To Length 29

Pad Spaces To Length 30

Stop Pad Spaces

Pad Data with Zeros
To pad data to the left, scan the bar code containing the desired number of zeros. This parameter is activated by Send commands.

Pad Zeros To Length 1

Pad Zeros To Length 2

Pad Zeros To Length 3

15-42 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Pad Data with Zeros (continued)

Pad Zeros To Length 4

Pad Zeros To Length 5

Pad Zeros To Length 6

Pad Zeros To Length 7

Pad Zeros To Length 8

Pad Zeros To Length 9

Pad Zeros To Length 10

Advanced Data Formatting 15-43

Pad Data with Zeros (continued)

Pad Zeros To Length 11

Pad Zeros To Length 12

Pad Zeros To Length 13

Pad Zeros To Length 14

Pad Zeros To Length 15

Pad Zeros To Length 16

Pad Zeros To Length 17

15-44 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Pad Data with Zeros (continued)

Pad Zeros To Length 18

Pad Zeros To Length 19

Pad Zeros To Length 20

Pad Zeros To Length 21

Pad Zeros To Length 22

Pad Zeros To Length 23

Pad Zeros To Length 24

Advanced Data Formatting 15-45

Pad Data with Zeros (continued)

Pad Zeros To Length 25

Pad Zeros To Length 26

Pad Zeros To Length 27

Pad Zeros To Length 28

Pad Zeros To Length 29

Pad Zeros To Length 30

Stop Pad Zeros

15-46 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Beeps
Select a beep sequence for each ADF rule.

Beep Once

Beep Twice

Beep Three Times

Send Keystroke (Control Characters and Keyboard Characters)
Control Characters
Scan the “Send __” bar code for the keystroke to send

Send Control 2

Send Control A

Send Control B

Advanced Data Formatting 15-47

Control Characters (continued)

Send Control C

Send Control D

Send Control E

Send Control F

Send Control G

Send Control H

Send Control I

15-48 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Control Characters (continued)

Send Control J

Send Control K

Send Control L

Send Control M

Send Control N

Send Control O

Send Control P

Advanced Data Formatting 15-49

Control Characters (continued)

Send Control Q

Send Control R

Send Control S

Send Control T

Send Control U

Send Control V

Send Control W

15-50 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Control Characters (continued)

Send Control X

Send Control Y

Send Control Z

Send Control [

Send Control \

Send Control ]

Advanced Data Formatting 15-51

Control Characters (continued)

Send Control 6

Send Control -

Keyboard Characters
Scan the “Send __” bar code for the keyboard characters to send.

Send Space

Send !

Send “

Send #

15-52 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send $

Send %

Send &

Send ‘

Send (

Send )

Send *

Advanced Data Formatting 15-53

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send +

Send ,

Send -

Send .

Send /

Send 0

Send 1

15-54 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send 2

Send 3

Send 4

Send 5

Send 6

Send 7

Send 8

Advanced Data Formatting 15-55

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send 9

Send :

Send ;

Send <

Send =

Send >

Send ?

15-56 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send @

Send A

Send B

Send C

Send D

Send E

Send F

Advanced Data Formatting 15-57

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send G

Send H

Send I

Send J

Send K

Send L

Send M

15-58 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send N

Send O

Send P

Send Q

Send R

Send S

Send T

Advanced Data Formatting 15-59

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send U

Send V

Send W

Send X

Send Y

Send Z

Send [

15-60 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send \

Send ]

Send ^

Send _

Send `

Send a

Send b

Advanced Data Formatting 15-61

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send c

Send d

Send e

Send f

Send g

Send h

Send i

15-62 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send j

Send k

Send l

Send m

Send n

Send o

Send p

Advanced Data Formatting 15-63

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send q

Send r

Send s

Send t

Send u

Send v

Send w

15-64 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Keyboard Characters (continued)

Send x

Send y

Send z

Send {

Send |

Send }

Send ~

Advanced Data Formatting 15-65

Send ALT Characters

Send Alt 2

Send Alt A

Send Alt B

Send Alt C

Send Alt D

Send Alt E

Send Alt F

15-66 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send ALT Characters (continued)

Send Alt G

Send Alt H

Send Alt I

Send Alt J

Send Alt K

Send Alt L

Send Alt M

Advanced Data Formatting 15-67

Send ALT Characters (continued)

Send Alt N

Send Alt O

Send Alt P

Send Alt Q

Send Alt R

Send Alt S

Send Alt T

15-68 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send ALT Characters (continued)

Send Alt U

Send Alt V

Send Alt W

Send Alt X

Send Alt Y

Send Alt Z

Send Alt [

Advanced Data Formatting 15-69

Send ALT Characters (continued)

Send Alt \

Send Alt ]

Send Alt 6

Send Alt -

15-70 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Keypad Characters

Send Keypad *

Send Keypad +

Send Keypad -

Send Keypad .

Send Keypad /

Send Keypad 0

Send Keypad 1

Advanced Data Formatting 15-71

Send Keypad Characters (continued)

Send Keypad 2

Send Keypad 3

Send Keypad 4

Send Keypad 5

Send Keypad 6

Send Keypad 7

Send Keypad 8

15-72 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Keypad Characters (continued)

Send Keypad 9

Send Keypad Enter

Send Keypad Numlock

Send Break Key

Send Delete Key

Send Page Up Key

Send End Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-73

Send Keypad Characters (continued)

Send Page Down Key

Send Pause Key

Send Scroll Lock Key

Send Backspace Key

Send Tab Key

Send Print Screen Key

Send Insert Key

15-74 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Keypad Characters (continued)

Send Home Key

Send Enter Key

Send Escape Key

Send Up Arrow Key

Send Down Arrow Key

Send Left Arrow Key

Send Right Arrow Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-75

Send Function Key

Send F1 Key

Send F2 Key

Send F3 Key

Send F4 Key

Send F5 Key

Send F6 Key

Send F7 Key

15-76 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Function Key (continued)

Send F8 Key

Send F9 Key

Send F10 Key

Send F11 Key

Send F12 Key

Send F13 Key

Send F14 Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-77

Send Function Key (continued)

Send F15 Key

Send F16 Key

Send F17 Key

Send F18 Key

Send F19 Key

Send F20 Key

Send F21 Key

15-78 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Function Key (continued)

Send F22 Key

Send F23 Key

Send F24 Key

Send PF1 Key

Send PF2 Key

Send PF3 Key

Send PF4 Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-79

Send Function Key (continued)

Send PF5 Key

Send PF6 Key

Send PF7 Key

Send PF8 Key

Send PF9 Key

Send PF10 Key

Send PF11 Key

15-80 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Function Key (continued)

Send PF12 Key

Send PF13 Key

Send PF14 Key

Send PF15 Key

Send PF16 Key

Send PF17 Key

Send PF18 Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-81

Send Function Key (continued)

Send PF19 Key

Send PF20 Key

Send PF21 Key

Send PF22 Key

Send PF23 Key

Send PF24 Key

Send PF25 Key

15-82 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Function Key (continued)

Send PF26 Key

Send PF27 Key

Send PF28 Key

Send PF29 Key

Send PF30 Key

Send Right Control Key
The “Send Right Control Key” action will send a tap (press and release) of the Right Control Key.

Send Right Control Key

Advanced Data Formatting 15-83

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters
The “Send Graphic User Interface Character” actions will tap the specified key while holding the System Dependent Graphic User
Interface (GUI) Key. The definition of the Graphic User Interface key is dependant upon the attached system:

Send GUI 0

Send GUI 1

Send GUI 2

Send GUI 3

Send GUI 4

Send GUI 5

15-84 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters (conitinued)

Send GUI 6

Send GUI 7

Send GUI 8

Send GUI 9

Send GUI A

Send GUI B

Send GUI C

Advanced Data Formatting 15-85

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters (conitinued)

Send GUI D

Send GUI E

Send GUI F

Send GUI G

Send GUI H

Send GUI I

Send GUI J

15-86 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters (conitinued)

Send GUI K

Send GUI L

Send GUI M

Send GUI N

Send GUI O

Send GUI P

Send GUI Q

Advanced Data Formatting 15-87

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters (conitinued)

Send GUI R

Send GUI S

Send GUI T

Send GUI U

Send GUI V

Send GUI W

Send GUI X

15-88 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Send Graphic User Interface (GUI) Characters (conitinued)

Send GUI Y

Send GUI Z

Turn On/Off Rule Sets
Use these bar codes to turn rule sets on and off.

Turn On Rule Set 1

Turn On Rule Set 2

Turn On Rule Set 3

Turn On Rule Set 4

Advanced Data Formatting 15-89

Turn On/Off Rule Sets (continued)
Use these bar codes to turn rule sets on and off.

Turn Off Rule Set 1

Turn Off Rule Set 2

Turn Off Rule Set 3

Turn Off Rule Set 4

15-90 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard

Space

#

$

%

*

+

(Dash)

Advanced Data Formatting 15-91

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

.

/

!

“

&

‘

(

15-92 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

)

:

;

<

=

>

?

Advanced Data Formatting 15-93

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

@

[

\

]

^

_
(Underscore)

`

15-94 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)
Numeric bar codes below should not be confused with those on the numeric keypad.

0

1

2

3

4

5

Advanced Data Formatting 15-95

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

6

7

8

9

A

B

C

15-96 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

D

E

F

G

H

I

J

Advanced Data Formatting 15-97

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

K

L

M

N

O

P

Q

15-98 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

R

S

T

U

V

W

X

Advanced Data Formatting 15-99

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

Y

Z

Cancel

End of Message

a

b

c

15-100 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

d

e

f

g

h

i

j

Advanced Data Formatting 15-101

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

k

l

m

n

o

p

q

15-102 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

r

s

t

u

v

w

x

Advanced Data Formatting 15-103

Alphanumeric Keyboard (continued)

y

z

{

|

}

~

15-104 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Standard Default Parameters

A-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Standard Default Parameters

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

User Preferences
Set Default Parameter

All Defaults

4-5

Parameter Scanning

ECh

Enable

4-5

Beeper Tone

91h

Medium

4-6

Beeper Volume

8Ch

High

4-7

Power Mode

80h

Continuous On

4-7

Time Delay to Low Power Mode

92h

5 Minutes

4-8

Trigger Mode

8Ah

Level

4-9

Decode Session Timeout

88h

9.9 Sec

4-10

Timeout Between Decodes, Same Symbol

89h

0.6 Sec

4-10

Beep After Good Decode

38h

Enable

4-11

Scanstand Session Timeout

F0h 90h

2 Seconds

4-11

Focus Mode

F0h A6h

Far Focus

5-5

Decoding Illumination

F0h 2Ah

Enable

5-6

Decode Aiming Pattern

F0h 32h

Enable

5-6

Keyboard Wedge Host Type

IBM PC/AT& IBM PC Compatibles1

6-5

Country Types (Country Codes)

North American

6-6

Ignore Unknown Characters

Transmit

6-8

Keystroke Delay

No Delay

6-8

Intra-Keystroke Delay

Disable

6-9

Alternate Numeric Keypad Emulation

Disable

6-9

Caps Lock On

Disable

6-10

Caps Lock Override

Disable

6-10

Decoding Preferences

Keyboard Wedge Host Parameters

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

A-3

A-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Convert Wedge Data

No Convert

6-11

Function Key Mapping

Disable

6-11

FN1 Substitution

Disable

6-12

Send and Make Break

Send

6-12

RS-232 Host Types

Standard1

7-8

Baud Rate

9600

7-10

Parity Type

None

7-11

Stop Bit Select

1 Stop Bit

7-12

Data Bits

8-Bit

7-12

Check Receive Errors

Enable

7-13

Hardware Handshaking

None

7-15

Software Handshaking

None

7-16

Host Serial Response Time-out

2 Sec

7-17

RTS Line State

Low RTS

7-18

Beep on 

Disable

7-18

Intercharacter Delay

0 msec

7-19

Nixdorf Beep/LED Options

Normal Operation

7-20

Ignore Unknown Characters

Send Bar Code

7-20

USB Device Type

HID Keyboard Emulation

8-5

USB Country Keyboard Types (Country Codes)

North American

8-6

USB Keystroke Delay

No Delay

8-8

USB CAPS Lock Override

Disable

8-8

USB Ignore Unknown Characters

Enable

8-9

Emulate Keypad

Disable

8-9

USB Keyboard FN1 Substitution

Disable

8-10

RS-232 Host Parameters

USB Host Parameters

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

Standard Default Parameters

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Function Key Mapping

Disable

8-10

Simulated Caps Lock

Disable

8-11

Convert Case

No Case Conversion

8-11

Port Address

None Selected

9-5

Convert Unknown to Code 39

Disable

9-6

Wand Emulation Host Types

Symbol OmniLink Interface Controller1

10-5

Leading Margin

80 msec

10-6

Polarity

Bar High/Margin Low

10-7

Ignore Unknown Characters

Ignore

10-7

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39

Disable

10-8

Convert Code 39 to Full ASCII

Disable

10-9

Beep Style

Beep on Successful Transmit

11-6

Parameter Pass-Through

Parameter Process and Pass Through

11-7

Convert Newer Code Types

Convert Newer Code Types

11-7

Module Width

20 µs

11-8

Convert All Bar Codes to Code 39

Do Not Convert to Code 39

11-8

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

Disable

11-9

Transmission Timeout

3 seconds

11-9

Ignore Unknown Characters

Ignore Unknown Characters

11-10

Leading Margin

2 ms

11-11

Check for Decode LED

Check for Decode LED

11-12

None1

12-3

IBM 468X/469X Host Parameters

Wand Emulation Host Parameters

Undecoded Scanner Emulation

123Scan Configuration Tool
123Scan Configuration

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

A-5

A-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

UPC/EAN
UPC-A

01h

Enable

13-10

UPC-E

02h

Enable

13-10

UPC-E1

0Ch

Disable

13-11

EAN-8/JAN 8

04h

Enable

13-11

EAN-13/JAN 13

03h

Enable

13-12

Bookland EAN

53h

Disable

13-12

Decode UPC/EAN/JAN Supplementals (2 and 5 digits)

10h

Ignore

13-13

UPC/EAN/JAN Supplemental Redundancy

50h

10

13-14

Transmit UPC-A Check Digit

28h

Enable

13-15

Transmit UPC-E Check Digit

29h

Enable

13-15

Transmit UPC-E1 Check Digit

2Ah

Enable

13-16

UPC-A Preamble

22h

System Character

13-16

UPC-E Preamble

23h

System Character

13-17

UPC-E1 Preamble

24h

System Character

13-18

Convert UPC-E to A

25h

Disable

13-18

Convert UPC-E1 to A

26h

Disable

13-19

EAN-8/JAN-8 Extend

27h

Disable

13-19

UCC Coupon Extended Code

55h

Disable

13-20

Code 128

08h

Enable

13-20

UCC/EAN-128

0Eh

Enable

13-21

ISBT 128

54h

Enable

13-21

Code 39

00h

Enable

13-22

Trioptic Code 39

0Dh

Disable

13-22

Convert Code 39 to Code 32 (Italian Pharmacy Code)

56h

Disable

13-23

Code 128

Code 39

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

Standard Default Parameters

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

Code 32 Prefix

E7h

Disable

13-23

Set Length(s) for Code 39

12h 13h

2 to 55

13-24

Code 39 Check Digit Verification

30h

Disable

13-25

Transmit Code 39 Check Digit

2Bh

Disable

13-26

Code 39 Full ASCII Conversion

11h

Disable

13-26

Buffer Code 39

71h

Disable

13-27

Code 93

09h

Disable

13-29

Set Length(s) for Code 93

1Ah 1Bh

4 to 55

13-30

Code 11

0Ah

Disable

13-31

Set Lengths for Code 11

1Ch 1Dh

4 to 55

13-32

Code 11 Check Digit Verification

34h

Disable

13-33

Transmit Code 11 Check Digit(s)

2Fh

Disable

13-34

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF)

06h

Enable

13-34

Set Lengths for I 2 of 5

16h 17h

14

13-35

I 2 of 5 Check Digit Verification

31h

Disable

13-36

Transmit I 2 of 5 Check Digit

2Ch

Disable

13-37

Convert I 2 of 5 to EAN 13

52h

Disable

13-37

Discrete 2 of 5

05h

Disable

13-38

Set Length(s) for D 2 of 5

14h 15h

12

13-38

Codabar

07h

Disable

13-39

Set Lengths for Codabar

18h 19h

5 to 55

13-40

CLSI Editing

36h

Disable

13-41

Code 93

Code 11

Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF)

Discrete 2 of 5 (DTF)

Codabar (NW - 7)

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

A-7

A-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter
NOTIS Editing

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

37h

Disable

13-41

MSI

0Bh

Disable

13-42

Set Length(s) for MSI

1Eh 1Fh

1 to 55

13-42

MSI Check Digits

32h

One

13-43

Transmit MSI Check Digit

2Eh

Disable

13-44

MSI Check Digit Algorithm

33h

Mod 10/Mod 10

13-44

US Postnet

59h

Enable

13-45

US Planet

5Ah

Enable

13-45

UK Postal

5Bh

Enable

13-46

Transmit UK Postal Check Digit

60h

Enable

13-46

Japan Postal

F0h 22h

Enable

13-47

Australian Postal

F0h 23h

Enable

13-47

Dutch Postal

F0h 46h

Enable

13-48

Transmit US Postal Check Digit

5Fh

Enable

13-48

RSS 14

F0h 52h

Enable

13-49

RSS Limited

F0h 53h

Enable

13-49

RSS Expanded

F0h 54h

Enable

13-50

Convert RSS to UPC/EAN

F0h 8Dh

Disable

13-50

Composite CC-C

F0h 55h

Disable

13-51

Composite CC-A/B

F0h 56h

Disable

13-51

Composite TLC-39

F0h 73h

Disable

13-52

UPC Composite Mode

F0h 58h

Always Linked

13-53

Composite Beep Mode

F0h 8Eh

Beep As Each Code Type is Decoded

13-54

MSI

Postal Codes

RSS (Reduced Space Symbology)

Composite

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

Standard Default Parameters

Table A-1. Standard Default Parameters Table (Continued)
Parameter
UCC/EAN Code 128 Emulation Mode for UCC/EAN
Composite Codes

Parameter
Number

Default

Page
Number

F0h ABh

Disable

13-54

PDF417

0Fh

Enable

13-55

MicroPDF417

E3h

Disable

13-55

Code 128 Emulation

7Bh

Disable

13-56

Data Matrix

F0h 24h

Enable

13-57

Maxicode

F0h 26h

Enable

13-57

QR Code

F0h 25h

Enable

13-58

Redundancy Level

4Eh

1

13-59

Security Level

4Dh

0

13-61

Intercharacter Gap Size

F0h 7Dh

Normal

13-62

2D Symbologies

Symbology-Specific Security Levels

Report Version

13-62

Macro PDF
Flush Macro PDF Buffer

13-63

Abort Macro PDF Entry

13-63

Miscellaneous Scanner Options
Transmit Code ID Character

2Dh

None

14-5

Prefix Value

63h, 69h

7013 

14-6

Suffix 1 Value
Suffix 2 Value

62h, 68h
64h, 6Ah

7013 

14-6

Scan Data Transmission Format

EBh

Data as is

14-7

FN1 Substitution Values

67h, 6Dh

Set

14-8

Transmit “No Read” Message

5Eh

Disable

14-9

Synapse Interface

F0h ACh

Standard

14-10

1User selection is required to configure this interface and this is the most common selection.

A-9

A-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Programming Reference
Symbol Code Identifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
AIM Code Identifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-4

B-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Programming Reference

Symbol Code Identifiers
Table B-1. Symbol Code Characters
Code Character

Code Type

A

UPC-A, UPC-E, UPC-E1, EAN-8, EAN-13

B

Code 39, Code 32

C

Codabar

D

Code 128

E

Code 93

F

Interleaved 2 of 5

G

Discrete 2 of 5, or Discrete 2 of 5 IATA

H

Code 11

J

MSI

K

UCC/EAN-128

L

Bookland EAN

M

Trioptic Code 39

N

Coupon Code

R

RSS Family

T

UCC Composite, TLC 39

X

PDF417, Macro PDF417, Micro PDF417

P00

Data Matrix

P01

QR Code

P02

Maxicode

P03

US Postnet

P04

US Planet

P05

Japan Postal

P06

UK Postal

P08

Dutch Postal

P09

Australian Postal

P09

UK Postal

B-3

B-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

AIM Code Identifiers
Each AIM Code Identifier contains the three-character string ]cm where:
]
c
m

=
=
=

Flag Character (ASCII 93)
Code Character (see Table B-2)
Modifier Character (see Table B-3)

Table B-2. Aim Code Characters
Code Character

Code Type

A

Code 39, Code 39 Full ASCII, Code 32

C

Code 128, Coupon (Code 128 portion)

d

Data Matrix

E

UPC/EAN, Coupon (UPC portion)

e

RSS Family

F

Codabar

G

Code 93

H

Code 11

I

Interleaved 2 of 5

L

PDF417, Macro PDF417, Micro PDF417

M

MSI

Q

QR Code

S

Discrete 2 of 5, IATA 2 of 5

U

Maxicode

X

Bookland EAN, Trioptic Code 39, US Postnet,
US Planet, UK Postal, Japan Postal, Australian
Postal, Dutch Postal

Programming Reference

The modifier character is the sum of the applicable option values based on Table B-3.

Table B-3. Modifier Characters
Code Type

Code 39

Option Value

Option

0

No check character or Full ASCII processing.

1

Reader has checked one check character.

3

Reader has checked and stripped check character.

4

Reader has performed Full ASCII character conversion.

5

Reader has performed Full ASCII character conversion and checked one check character.

7

Reader has performed Full ASCII character conversion and checked and stripped check character.

Example: A Full ASCII bar code with check character W, A+I+MI+DW, is transmitted as ]A7AIMID where 7 = (3+4).
0

No option specified at this time. Always transmit 0.

Trioptic Code 39
Example: A Trioptic bar code 412356 is transmitted as ]X0412356
0

Standard data packet, no Function code 1 in first symbol position.

1

Function code 1 in first symbol character position.

Code 128
2

Function code 1 in second symbol character position.
Example: A Code (EAN) 128 bar code with Function 1 character FNC1 in the first position, AIMID is transmitted as ]C1AIMID
0

No check digit processing.

1

Reader has validated check digit.

3

Reader has validated and stripped check digit.

I 2 of 5
Example: An I 2 of 5 bar code without check digit, 4123, is transmitted as ]I04123
0

No check digit processing.

1

Reader has checked check digit.

3

Reader has stripped check digit before transmission.

Codabar
Example: A Codabar bar code without check digit, 4123, is transmitted as ]F04123
0

No options specified at this time. Always transmit 0.

Code 93
Example: A Code 93 bar code 012345678905 is transmitted as ]G0012345678905

MSI

0

Check digits are sent.

1

No check digit is sent.

Example: An MSI bar code 4123, with a single check digit checked, is transmitted as ]M14123
0

No options specified at this time. Always transmit 0.

D 2 of 5
Example: A D 2 of 5 bar code 4123, is transmitted as ]S04123

UPC/EAN

0

Standard packet in full EAN country code format, which is 13 digits for UPC-A and UPC-E (not including
supplemental data).

1

Two-digit supplement data only.

2

Five-digit supplement data only.

4

EAN-8 data packet.

Example: A UPC-A bar code 012345678905 is transmitted as ]E00012345678905

B-5

B-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table B-3. Modifier Characters (Continued)
Code Type

Option Value
0

Option
No options specified at this time. Always transmit 0.

Bookland EAN
Example: A Bookland EAN bar code 123456789X is transmitted as ]X0123456789X

Code 11

0

Single check digit

1

Two check digits

3

Check characters validated but not transmitted.
No option specified at this time. Always transmit 0. RSS-14 and RSS-Limited transmit with an Application
Identifier “01”.
Note: In UCC/EAN-128 emulation mode, RSS is transmitted using Code 128 rules (i.e., ]C1).

RSS Family

Example: An RSS-14 bar code 100123456788902 is transmitted as ]e001100123456788902.
Native mode transmission.
Note: UPC portion of composite is transmitted using UPC rules.
0
1
EAN.UCC Composites
2
(RSS, UCC/EAN-128, 2D
portion of UPC
composite)
3

Standard data packet.
Data packet containing the data following an encoded symbol separator character.
Data packet containing the data following an escape mechanism character. The data packet does not
support the ECI protocol.
Data packet containing the data following an escape mechanism character. The data packet supports the
ECI protocol.
UCC/EAN-128 emulation
Note: UPC portion of composite is transmitted using UPC rules.

1

Data packet is a UCC/EAN-128 symbol (i.e., data is preceded with ]JC1).

0

Reader set to conform to protocol defined in 1994 PDF417 symbology specifications. Note: When this
option is transmitted, the receiver cannot reliably determine whether ECIs have been invoked or whether
data byte 92DEC has been doubled in transmission.

1

Reader set to follow the ECI protocol (Extended Channel Interpretation). All data characters 92DEC are
doubled.

2

Reader set for Basic Channel operation (no escape character transmission protocol). Data characters 92DEC
are not doubled. Note: When decoders are set to this mode, unbuffered Macro symbols and symbols
requiring the decoder to convey ECI escape sequences cannot be transmitted.

3

The bar code contains a UCC/EAN-128 symbol, and the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915.

4

The bar code contains a UCC/EAN-128 symbol, and the first codeword is in the range 908-909.

5

The bar code contains a UCC/EAN-128 symbol, and the first codeword is in the range 910-911.

PDF417, Micro PDF417

Example: A PDF417 bar code ABCD, with no transmission protocol enabled, is transmitted as ]L2ABCD.

Data Matrix

0

ECC 000-140, not supported.

1

ECC 200.

2

ECC 200, FNC1 in first or fifth position.

3

ECC 200, FNC1 in second or sixth position.

4

ECC 200, ECI protocol implemented.

5

ECC 200, FNC1 in first or fifth position, ECI protocol implemented.

6

ECC 200, FNC1 in second or sixth position, ECI protocol implemented.

Programming Reference

Table B-3. Modifier Characters (Continued)
Code Type

Option Value

Option

0

Symbol in Mode 4 or 5.

1

Symbol in Mode 2 or 3.

2

Symbol in Mode 4 or 5, ECI protocol implemented.

3

Symbol in Mode 2 or 3, ECI protocol implemented in secondary message.

0

Model 1 symbol.

1

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol not implemented.

2

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol implemented.

3

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol not implemented, FNC1 implied in first position.

4

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol implemented, FNC1 implied in first position.

5

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol not implemented, FNC1 implied in second position.

6

Model 2 symbol, ECI protocol implemented, FNC1 implied in second position.

MaxiCode

QR Code

B-7

B-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Sample Bar Codes
Code 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-3
UPC-A, 100 %. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-3
EAN-13, 100 %. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-3
Code 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-3
Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-4
RSS 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-4
PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-4
Data Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-4
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-5
QR Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-5
US Postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-5
UK Postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-5

C-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Sample Bar Codes C-3

Code 39

123ABC

UPC/EAN
UPC-A, 100 %

0

12345 67890

5

EAN-13, 100 %

3 4 5 67 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 0

Code 128

12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234

C-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Interleaved 2 of 5

12345678901231

RSS 14
RSS 14 must be enabled to read the bar code below (see RSS-14 on page 13-49).

Note

7612341562341

PDF417

Data Matrix

Sample Bar Codes C-5

Maxicode

QR Code

US Postnet

UK Postal

C-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Numeric Bar Codes
Numeric Bar Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3
Cancel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4

D-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Numeric Bar Codes D-3

Numeric Bar Codes
For parameters requiring specific numeric values, scan the appropriately numbered bar code(s).

0

1

2

3

4

5

D-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Numeric Bar Codes
For parameters requiring specific numeric values, scan the appropriately numbered bar code(s).

6

7

8

9

Cancel
To correct an error or change a selection, scan the bar code below.

Cancel

ASCII Character Sets

E-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

ASCII Character Sets E-3

Table E-1. ASCII Value Table
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1000

%U

CTRL 2

1001

$A

CTRL A

1002

$B

CTRL B

1003

$C

CTRL C

1004

$D

CTRL D

1005

$E

CTRL E

1006

$F

CTRL F

1007

$G

CTRL G

1008

$H

CTRL H/BACKSPACE1

1009

$I

CTRL I/HORIZONTAL TAB1

1010

$J

CTRL J

1011

$K

CTRL K

1012

$L

CTRL L

1013

$M

CTRL M/ENTER1

1014

$N

CTRL N

1015

$O

CTRL O

1016

$P

CTRL P

1017

$Q

CTRL Q

1018

$R

CTRL R

1019

$S

CTRL S

1020

$T

CTRL T

1021

$U

CTRL U

1022

$V

CTRL V

1023

$W

CTRL W

1024

$X

CTRL X

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the Function Key Mapping is enabled. Otherwise, the unbold keystroke is sent.

E-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table E-1. ASCII Value Table (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1025

$Y

CTRL Y

1026

$Z

CTRL Z

1027

%A

CTRL [

1028

%B

CTRL \

1029

%C

CTRL ]

1030

%D

CTRL 6

1031

%E

CTRL -

1032

Space

Space

1033

/A

!

1034

/B

“

1035

/C

#

1036

/D

$

1037

/E

%

1038

/F

&

1039

/G

‘

1040

/H

(

1041

/I

)

1042

/J

*

1043

/K

+

1044

/L

,

1045

-

-

1046

.

.

1047

/o

/

1048

0

0

1049

1

1

1050

2

2

1051

3

3

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the Function Key Mapping is enabled. Otherwise, the unbold keystroke is sent.

ASCII Character Sets E-5

Table E-1. ASCII Value Table (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1052

4

4

1053

5

5

1054

6

6

1055

7

7

1056

8

8

1057

9

9

1058

/Z

:

1059

%F

;

1060

%G

<

1061

%H

=

1062

%I

>

1063

%J

?

1064

%V

@

1065

A

A

1066

B

B

1067

C

C

1068

D

D

1069

E

E

1070

F

F

1071

G

G

1072

H

H

1073

I

I

1074

J

J

1075

K

K

1076

L

L

1077

M

M

1078

N

N

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the Function Key Mapping is enabled. Otherwise, the unbold keystroke is sent.

E-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table E-1. ASCII Value Table (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1079

O

O

1080

P

P

1081

Q

Q

1082

R

R

1083

S

S

1084

T

T

1085

U

U

1086

V

V

1087

W

W

1088

X

X

1089

Y

Y

1090

Z

Z

1091

%K

[

1092

%L

\

1093

%M

]

1094

%N

^

1095

%O

_

1096

%W

‘

1097

+A

a

1098

+B

b

1099

+C

c

1100

+D

d

1101

+E

e

1102

+F

f

1103

+G

g

1104

+H

h

1105

+I

i

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the Function Key Mapping is enabled. Otherwise, the unbold keystroke is sent.

ASCII Character Sets E-7

Table E-1. ASCII Value Table (Continued)
Full ASCII Code 39
Encode Char

ASCII Value

Keystroke

1106

+J

j

1107

+K

k

1108

+L

l

1109

+M

m

1110

+N

n

1111

+O

o

1112

+P

p

1113

+Q

q

1114

+R

r

1115

+S

s

1116

+T

t

1117

+U

u

1118

+V

v

1119

+W

w

1120

+X

x

1121

+Y

y

1122

+Z

z

1123

%P

{

1124

%Q

I

1125

%R

}

1126

%S

~

The keystroke in bold is sent only if the Function Key Mapping is enabled. Otherwise, the unbold keystroke is sent.

E-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table E-2. ALT Key Standard Default Tables
ALT Keys

Keystroke

2064

ALT 2

2065

ALT A

2066

ALT B

2067

ALT C

2068

ALT D

2069

ALT E

2070

ALT F

2071

ALT G

2072

ALT H

2073

ALT I

2074

ALT J

2075

ALT K

2076

ALT L

2077

ALT M

2078

ALT N

2079

ALT O

2080

ALT P

2081

ALT Q

2082

ALT R

2083

ALT S

2084

ALT T

2085

ALT U

2086

ALT V

2087

ALT W

2088

ALT X

2089

ALT Y

2090

ALT Z

ASCII Character Sets E-9

Table 5-3. USB GUI Key Character Set
GUI Key

Keystroke

3000

Right Control Key

3048

GUI 0

3049

GUI 1

3050

GUI 2

3051

GUI 3

3052

GUI 4

3053

GUI 5

3054

GUI 6

3055

GUI 7

3056

GUI 8

3057

GUI 9

3065

GUI A

3066

GUI B

3067

GUI C

3068

GUI D

3069

GUI E

3070

GUI F

3071

GUI G

3072

GUI H

3073

GUI I

3074

GUI J

3075

GUI K

3076

GUI L

3077

GUI M

3078

GUI N

3079

GUI O

3080

GUI P

3081

GUI Q

3082

GUI R

3083

GUI S

3084

GUI T

3085

GUI U

3086

GUI V

Note: GUI Shift Keys - The Apple™ iMac keyboard has an apple key on either side of the space bar.
Windows-based systems have a GUI key to the left of the left ALT key, and to the right of the right ALT key.

E-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table 5-3. USB GUI Key Character Set (Continued)
GUI Key

Keystroke

3087

GUI W

3088

GUI X

3089

GUI Y

3090

GUI Z

Note: GUI Shift Keys - The Apple™ iMac keyboard has an apple key on either side of the space bar.
Windows-based systems have a GUI key to the left of the left ALT key, and to the right of the right ALT key.

Table E-4. PF Key Standard Default Table
PF Keys

Keystroke

4001

PF 1

4002

PF 2

4003

PF 3

4004

PF 4

4005

PF 5

4006

PF 6

4007

PF 7

4008

PF 8

4009

PF 9

4010

PF 10

4011

PF 11

4012

PF 12

4013

PF 13

4014

PF 14

4015

PF 15

4016

PF 16

ASCII Character Sets E-11

Table E-5. F key Standard Default Table
F Keys

Keystroke

5001

F1

5002

F2

5003

F3

5004

F4

5005

F5

5006

F6

5007

F7

5008

F8

5009

F9

5010

F 10

5011

F 11

5012

F 12

5013

F 13

5014

F 14

5015

F 15

5016

F 16

5017

F 17

5018

F 18

5019

F 19

5020

F 20

5021

F 21

5022

F 22

5023

F 23

5024

F 24

Table E-6. Numeric Key Standard Default Table
Numeric Keypad

Keystroke

6042

*

6043

+

6044

Undefined

6045

-

6046

.

6047

/

E-12 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Table E-6. Numeric Key Standard Default Table (Continued)
Numeric Keypad

Keystroke

6048

0

6049

1

6050

2

6051

3

6052

4

6053

5

6054

6

6055

7

6056

8

6057

9

6058

Enter

6059

Num Lock

Table E-7. Extended Keypad Standard Default Table
Extended Keypad

Keystroke

7001

Break

7002

Delete

7003

Pg Up

7004

End

7005

Pg Dn

7006

Pause

7007

Scroll Lock

7008

Backspace

7009

Tab

7010

Print Screen

7011

Insert

7012

Home

7013

Enter

7014

Escape

7015

Up Arrow

7016

Dn Arrow

7017

Left Arrow

7018

Right Arrow

Glossary

AIM

Automatic Identification Manufacturers, Inc. is the trade association for
manufacturers of automatic identification systems.

Alphanumeric

A character set that contains letters, numbers and other characters such as
special symbols.

Aperture

The opening in an optical system defined by a lens or baffle that establishes
the field of view.

ASCII

American Standard Code for Information Interchange.
A 7-bit-plus-parity code representing 128 letters, numerals, punctuation marks,
and control characters. It is a standard data transmission code in the U.S.

Aspect Ratio

The ratio of symbol height to symbol length in a 2-dimensional symbol.

Autodiscrimination

The ability of an interface controller to determine the code type of a scanned
bar code. After this determination is made, the information content is decoded.

Automatic Identification System

The application of various technologies, such as bar code recognition, image
recognition, voice recognition and RF/MW transponders, for the purpose of
data entry into a data processing system and bypassing the key-entry
component of traditional data entry.

Background

The area surrounding a printed symbol including the spaces and quiet zones.

Bar

The dark element in a printed bar code symbol.

Bar Code

An array of parallel rectangular bars and spaces arranged according to the
encodation rules of a particular symbol specification in order to represent data
in machine-readable form (i.e., Code 39).

Bar Code Character

A single group of bars and spaces which represent an individual number, letter,
punctuation mark or other symbol.

GL-2 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Bar Code Density

The number of characters represented per unit of measurement (e.g.,
characters per inch).

Bar Code Reader

A device used to read or decode a bar code symbol.

Bar Code Symbol

The combination of symbol characters and features required by a particular
symbology, including quiet zones, start and stop characters, data characters,
check characters and other auxiliary patterns, that together form a complete
scannable entity (see symbol).

Bar Height

The dimension of a bar measured perpendicular to the bar width.
or
The dimension of the individual bars in a bar code symbol or in a row of a multirow, 2-dimensional symbol that is measured perpendicular to the scanning
direction (see Y dimension).

Bar Width

Thickness of a bar measured from the edge closest to the symbol start
character to the trailing edge of the same bar.
or
The transverse dimension of an individual bar in a bar code symbol that is
measured parallel to the scanning direction. The number of possible width
variations within a particular printed symbol depends on the symbology used
(see X dimension).

Baud Rate

A measure of the data flow or number of signaling events occurring per second.
When one bit is the standard "event," this is a measure of bits per second (bps).
For example, a baud rate of 50 means transmission of 50 bits of data per
second.

Bi-directional

Denotes that a machine-readable symbol can be read successfully in two
directions – either backwards or forwards. Also identifies a scanner that can
operate or a bar code that can be read independent of scanning direction.

Binary

Denotes a numbering system to base 2 in which numbers are expressed as
combinations of the digits 0 and 1 with positional weighting based on powers
of 2. In computing, these can be represented electrically by 'off' and 'on'
respectively or in machine-readable symbols by narrow and wide elements or
by the absence or presence of a bar module.

Bit

Binary digit. One bit is the basic unit of binary information. Generally, eight
consecutive bits compose one byte of data. The pattern of 0 and 1 values within
the byte determines its meaning.

Byte

On an addressable boundary, eight adjacent binary digits (0 and 1) combined in
a pattern to represent a specific character or numeric value. Bits are numbered
from the right, 0 through 7, with bit 0 the low-order bit. One byte in memory is
used to store one ASCII character.
or
A sequential series of bits comprising one character and handled as one unit.
Usually encoded in the ASCII format, a byte usually consists of eight bits and
represents one alphabetic or special character, two decimal digits or eight
binary bits.

CDRH

Center for Devices and Radiological Health. A federal agency responsible for
regulating laser product safety. This agency specifies various laser operation
classes based on power output during operation.

CDRH Class 1

This is the lowest power CDRH laser classification. This class is considered
intrinsically safe, even if all laser output were directed into the eye's pupil.
There are no special operating procedures for this class.

GL-3

CDRH Class 2

No additional software mechanisms are needed to conform to this limit. Laser
operation in this class poses no danger for unintentional direct human
exposure.

Character

A pattern of bars and spaces which either directly represents data or indicates
a control function, such as a number, letter, punctuation mark, or
communications control contained in a message.

Character Set

Those characters available for encoding in a particular bar code symbology.

Check Digit

A digit used to verify a correct symbol decode. The scanner inserts the decoded
data into an arithmetic formula and checks that the resulting number matches
the encoded check digit. Check digits are required for UPC but are optional for
other symbologies. Using check digits decreases the chance of substitution
errors when a symbol is decoded.

Codabar

A discrete self-checking code with a character set consisting of digits 0 to 9 and
six additional characters: ( - $ : / , +).

Code

A set of unambiguous rules specifying the way in which data may be
represented as numbers and letters used to represent information (see number
system).

Code 128

A high density symbology which allows the controller to encode all 128 ASCII
characters without adding extra symbol elements.

Code 3 of 9 (Code 39)

A versatile and widely used alphanumeric bar code symbology with a set of 43
character types, including all uppercase letters, numerals from 0 to 9, and 7
special characters (- . / + % $ and space). The code name is derived from the
fact that 3 of 9 elements representing a character are wide, while the
remaining 6 are narrow.

Code 93

An industrial symbology compatible with Code 39 but offering a full character
ASCII set and a higher coding density than Code 39.

Code Length

Number of data characters in a bar code between the start and stop characters,
not including those characters.

Codeword

As a symbol character value, this isan intermediate level of coding between
source data and the graphical encodation in the symbol.

Concatination

The construction of a string of data from two or more strings by appending each
string in succession. The linking or chaining together of separate items of data
in a bar code symbol or of the data contained in two or more separate bar code
symbols (also referred to as message append and structured append).

Continuous Code

A bar code or symbol in which all spaces within the symbol are parts of
characters. There are no intercharacter gaps in a continuous code. The absence
of gaps allows for greater information density.

Contrast

The difference in reflectance between the black and white (or bar and space)
areas of a symbol.

Data Identifier

A specified character or string of characters that defines the intended use of
the data element that follows. For the purposes of automatic data capture
technologies, data identifier refers to the alphanumeric identifiers as defined
in ANSI MH10.8.2, formerly known as ANSI/FACT data identifiers.

GL-4 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Data Matrix

This error correcting, 2-dimensional matrix symbology was originally developed
in 1989, and a finalized design was completed in 1995 by International Data
Matrix. It's capable of encoding various character sets including strictly
numeric data, alphanumeric data and all ISO 646 (ASCII) characters, as well as
special character sets. The symbology has both error detection and error
correction features. Each Data Matrix symbol consists of data regions, which
contain nominally square modules set out in a regular array. A dark module is
a binary 1 and a light module is a binary 0. There is no specified minimum or
maximum for the X or Y dimension. The data region is surrounded by a finder
pattern, a perimeter to the data region that is 1 module wide, which is
surrounded by a quiet zone on all four sides of the symbol. Two adjacent sides
are solid dark lines used primarily to define physical size, orientation and
symbol distortion. The two opposite sides consist of alternating dark and light
modules. These are used primarily to define the cell structure but also assist in
determining physical size and distortion. There are 2 types of Data Matrix
symbologies: ECC 000 - 140 with several available levels of convolutional error
correction, and ECC 200, which uses Reed-Solomon error correction. For ISO/
IEC JTC 1/SC 31 purposes, only ECC 200 is recommended. The intellectual
property rights associated with Data Matrix have been committed to the public
domain.

Data Structure

The stipulation of the type of information that is included in a bar code, such as
its order and format.

Dead Zone

An area within a scanner's field of view, in which specular reflection may
prevent a successful decode.

Decode

To recognize a bar code symbology (e.g., UPC/EAN) and then analyze the
content of the specific bar code scanned.

Decode Algorithm

A decoding scheme that converts pulse widths into data representation of the
letters or numbers encoded within a bar code symbol.

Decoder

An electronic package that receives the signals from the scanning function,
performs the algorithm to interpret the signals into meaningful data and
provides the interface to other devices.

Depth of Field

The range between minimum and maximum distances at which a scanner can
read a symbol with a certain minimum element width.

Diffuse Reflection

The component of reflected light that emanates in all directions from the
reflecting surface.

Discrete 2 of 5

A binary bar code symbology representing each character by a group of five
bars, two of which are wide. The location of wide bars in the group determines
which character is encoded; spaces are insignificant. Only numeric characters
(0 to 9) and START/STOP characters may be encoded.

Discrete Code

A bar code or symbol in which the spaces between characters (intercharacter
gaps) are not part of the code.

EAN

European Article Number. This European/International version of the UPC
provides its own coding format and symbology standards. Element dimensions
are specified metrically. EAN is used primarily in retail.

GL-5

EAN/U.P.C.

A fixed-length, numeric 13-digit bar code symbol consisting of 30 dark
elements and 29 intervening light elements. Each character is represented by
2 bars and 2 spaces over 7 modules. A bar may be comprised of 1, 2, 3 or 4
modules. Each EAN/U.P.C. symbol consists of a leading quiet zone, a start
pattern, 7 left-hand data characters, a center bar pattern, 5 right-hand data
characters, a Modulo 10 check character, a stop pattern and a trailing quiet
zone. U.P.C. is often considered a 12-digit code. The 13th digit of EAN/U.P.C.
symbol is a derived character in the left-most position. In the case of U.P.C., this
derived left-most character is a 0.

Element

Generic term for a bar or space.

Encoded Area

Total linear dimension occupied by all characters of a code pattern, including
start/stop characters and data.

Error Correction

A reader or decoder's use of mathematical schemes to reconstruct or replace
damaged or missing symbol characters to enable the reading of the symbol
data.

Error Detection

This occurs when error-correction characters detect that the presence of errors
in the symbol exceeds the error correction capacity, and keeps the symbol from
being decoded as erroneous data.

Error-Correction Characters

Symbol characters used for error correction and detection, calculated
automatically from the other symbol characters.

Error-Correction Level

An indicator of the number of characters used in a symbology for error
correction. A higher level of error correction allows for correcting greater
potential symbol damage.

Error-Detection Characters

Symbol characters reserved for error detection that are calculated
automatically from the other symbol characters.

Fixed Beam Bar Code Reader

A scanning device where scanning motion is achieved by moving the object
relative to the reader; as opposed to a moving beam reader.

Guard Bars

Bars located at both ends and the center of a UPC and EAN symbol to provide
reference points for scanning.

Horizontal Bar Code

A bar code or symbol with an overall length dimension that is parallel to the
horizon, which resembles a picket fence.

Host Computer

A computer that serves other terminals in a network, providing such services
as computation, database access, supervisory programs, and network control.

IEC

International Electrotechnical Commission. This international agency regulates
laser safety by specifying various laser operation classes based on power
output during operation.

IEC (825) Class 1

This is the lowest power IEC laser classification. Conformity is ensured through
a software restriction of 120 seconds of laser operation within any 1000 second
window and an automatic laser shutdown if the scanner's oscillating mirror
fails.

Intercharacter Gap

The space between two adjacent bar code characters in a discrete code.

Interleaved 2 of 5

A binary bar code symbology representing character pairs in groups of five bars
and five interleaved spaces. Interleaving provides for greater information
density. The location of wide elements (bar/spaces) within each group
determines which characters are encoded. This continuous code type uses no
intercharacter spaces. Only numeric (0 to 9) and START/STOP characters may
be encoded.

Interleaved Bar Code

A bar code in which characters are paired together, using bars to represent the
first character and the intervening spaces to represent the second.

GL-6 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

LASER - Light Amplification by
Stimulated Emission of Radiation

The laser is an intense light source. Light from a laser is all the same frequency,
unlike the output of an incandescent bulb. Laser light is typically coherent and
has a high energy density.

Laser Diode

A gallium-arsenide semiconductor type of laser connected to a power source
to generate a laser beam. This laser type is a compact source of coherent light.

Laser Scanner

An optical bar code reading device using a coherent laser light beam as its
source of illumination.

LED Indicator

A semiconductor diode (LED - Light Emitting Diode) used as an indicator, often
in digital displays. The semiconductor uses applied voltage to produce light of
a certain frequency determined by the semiconductor's particular chemical
composition.

Matrix Symbols

A 2-dimensional array of regular polygon shaped cells where the center-tocenter distance of adjacent elements is uniform. The arrangement of the cells
represents data and/or symbology functions. Matrix symbols may include
recognition patterns that do not follow the same rule as the other elements
within the symbol (i.e., Data Matrix and MaxiCode).

MIL

1 mil = 1 thousandth of an inch; a unit of measure often used to quantify bar
code printing and scanning dimensions.

Misread (Misdecode)

A condition which occurs when the data output of a reader or interface
controller does not agree with the data encoded within a bar code symbol.

Module

(1) The narrowest nominal width unit of measure in a symbol. In certain
symbologies, element widths are specified as multiples of 1 module.
Equivalent to X dimension; or (2) a single cell in a matrix symbology used to
encode 1 bit of data. In MaxiCode, the module shape is a regular hexagon. In
Data Matrix, the module shape is nominally square. In PDF417, the module
shape is a regular rectangle. In bar code symbologies, the module shape is a
regular rectangle.

Module Check Digit or Character

A character within the symbol data field calculated using modular arithmetic
that is used for error detection. The calculated character is determined by
applying a code algorithm to the data field contents (see check character).

Moving Beam Bar Code Reader

A device where scanning motion is achieved by mechanically moving the
optical geometry.

MRD

Minimum reflectance difference: a formula that is used to determine if there
is an adequate difference between absorbed and reflected light.

Nanometer

Unit of measure used to define the wavelength of light that is equal to 10-9
meter.

Nominal

The exact (or ideal) intended value for a specified parameter. Tolerances are
specified as positive and negative deviations from this value.

Nominal Size

Standard size for a bar code symbol. Most UPC/EAN codes are used over a
range of magnifications (e.g., from 0.80 to 2.00 of nominal).

Non-Contact Reader/Scanner

Bar code readers requiring no physical contact with the printed symbol.

Non-read

The absence of data at the scanner output after an attempted scan, which is
due to no code, defective code, scanner failure or operator error.

Omnidirectional

Bar codes read in any orientation relative to the scanner.

Optical Throw

The distance from the scanner face to the closest point at which symbol can be
read; also, optical throw is the difference between range and depth of field.

GL-7

Orientation

The alignment of the symbol's scan path. Two possible orientations are
horizontal with vertical bars and spaces (picket fence) and vertical with
horizontal bars and spaces (ladder).

Overhead

The fixed number of characters required for start, stop and checking in a given
symbol. For example, a symbol requiring a start, stop and 2 check characters
contains 4 characters of overhead.

Parameter

A variable that can have different values assigned to it.

PDF417

An error correcting 2-dimensional multi-row symbol developed in 1992 by
Symbol Technologies, PDF417 symbols are constructed from 4 bars and 4
spaces over 17 modules. The symbol size is from 3 to 90 rows. There is no
specified minimum or maximum for X or Y dimension. With at least the
recommended minimum level of error correction, the recommended Y
dimension is 3X. With less than the minimum recommended level of error
correction, the recommended Y dimension is 4X. A quiet zone of 2X is specified
on each side of a symbol. Because of delta decode techniques, the symbology
is immune from uniform bar width growth. PDF417 supports cross-row
scanning. The intellectual property rights associated with PDF417 have been
committed to the public domain.

Percent Decode

The average probability that a single scan of a bar code would result in a
successful decode. In a well-designed bar code scanning system, that
probability should approach near 100%.

Pitch

Rotation of a bar code symbol in an axis parallel to the direction of the bars.

Plessey Code

A pulse-width, modulated bar code commonly used for shelf marking in grocery
stores.

Postnet Code

Code developed by the U.S. Postal Service to assist in the automatic sorting of
mail.

Print Contrast Signal (PCS)

Measurement of the contrast (brightness difference) between the bars and
spaces of a symbol. A minimum PCS value is needed for a bar code symbol to
be scannable. PCS = (RL - RD) / RL, where RL is the reflectance factor of the
background and RD the reflectance factor of the dark bars.

Programming Mode

The state in which a scanner is configured for parameter values. See
SCANNING MODE.

Quiet Zone

A clear space, containing no dark marks, which precedes the start character of
a bar code symbol and follows the stop character.

Reflectance

Amount of light returned from an illuminated surface.

Resolution

The narrowest element dimension which is distinguished by a particular
reading device or printed with a particular device or method.

RSS

Reduced Space Symbology: A family of space efficient symbologies developed
by UCC.EAN.

Scan Area

Area intended to contain a symbol.

Scanner

An electronic device used to scan bar code symbols and produce a digitized
pattern that corresponds to the bars and spaces of the symbol. Its three main
components are:
1. Light source (laser or photoelectric cell) - illuminates a bar code.
2. Photodetector - registers the difference in reflected light (more light
reflected from spaces).
3. Signal conditioning circuit - transforms optical detector output into a
digitized bar pattern.

Scanning Mode

The scanner is energized, programmed, and ready to read a bar code.

GL-8 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Scanning Sequence

A method of programming or configuring parameters for a bar code reading
system by scanning bar code menus.

Self-Checking Code

A symbology that uses a checking algorithm to detect encoding errors within
the characters of a bar code symbol.

Skew

Rotation of a bar code symbol on an axis parallel to the symbol's length.

Space

The lighter element of a bar code formed by the background between bars.

Space Width

The thickness of a space measured from the edge closest to the symbol start
character to the trailing edge of the same space.

Specular Reflection

The mirror-like direct reflection of light from a surface, which can cause
difficulty decoding a bar code.

Stacked Symbol (2D Symbols)

A 2-dimensional (2D) symbol with sequences of linear (width-coded) data that
are stacked one upon another (i.e., PDF417).

Start/Stop Character

A pattern of bars and spaces that provides the scanner with start and stop
reading instructions and scanning direction. The start and stop characters are
normally to the left and right margins of a horizontal code.

Substrate

A foundation material on which a substance or image is placed.

Symbol

A scannable unit that encodes data within the conventions of a certain
symbology, usually including start/stop characters, quiet zones, data
characters, and check characters.

Symbol Aspect Ratio

The ratio of symbol height to symbol width.

Symbol Density

The number of data characters per unit length; usually expressed as characters
per inch (CPI).

Symbol Height

The distance between the outside edges of the quiet zones of the first row and
the last row.

Symbol Length

Length of symbol measured from the beginning of the quiet zone (margin)
adjacent to the start character to the end of the quiet zone (margin) adjacent
to a stop character.

Symbology

The structural rules and conventions for representing data within a particular
bar code type (e.g. UPC/EAN, Code 39).

Tilt

Rotation of a bar code symbol on an axis perpendicular to the substrate.

Tolerance

Allowable deviation from the nominal bar or space width.

Two-dimensional symbology

A machine-readable symbol which must be examined both vertically and
horizontally to read the entire message.
A 2-dimensional (2D) symbol may be one of two types of machine-readable
symbols: a Matrix Symbol or a stacked symbol. 2D symbols differ from linear
bar codes with the ability for high data content, small size, data efficiency and
error correction capability.

UCC

Uniform Code Council: the organization that administers the U.P.C and other
retail standards.

UCC.EAN-128

Code 128 with a Function 1 character in the first position that is the symbology
used with the UCC.EAN format for a universal product number (UPN).

UPC

Universal Product Code. A relatively complex numeric symbology. Each
character consists of two bars and two spaces, each of which is any of four
widths. The standard symbology for retail food packages in the United States.

Variable Length Code

A code with a number of encoded characters within a range, as opposed to a
code with a fixed number of encoded characters.

GL-9

Vertical Bar Code

A bar code pattern presented in such orientation that the symbol from start to
stop is perpendicular to the horizon. The individual bars are in an array
appearing as rungs of a ladder.

Visible Laser Diode (VLD)

A solid state device which produces visible laser light.

Wand Scanner

A handheld scanning device used as a contact bar code or OCR reader.

Wedge

A device that plugs in between a keyboard and a terminal and allows data to
be entered by a keyboard or by various types of scanners.

X Dimension

The dimension of the narrowest bar and narrowest space in a bar code.

Y Dimension

The height of the modules in a row of a 2-dimensional (2D) symbols.

GL-10 DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Index
Numerics
123Scan parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-3
2D bar codes
code 128 emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-56
Data Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
MicroPDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-55
QR code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-58

A
actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-4
ADF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-3
actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3, 15-27
move cursor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-31
send data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-27
setup fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
alphanumeric keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-90
alternate rule sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
bar code menu example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-4
beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
code lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-17
code types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-11
criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3, 15-11
default rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
move cursor past a character . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
move cursor to a character . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
move cursor to start of data . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
numeric keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-24, 15-25
pad spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-37

pad zeros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-41
rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
rules hierarchy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-6
send alt characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-65
send control characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-46
send function key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-75
send keyboard characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-51
send keypad characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-70
send preset value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-30
send value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-35
skip ahead characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-32
skip ahead "n" characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-30
skip back characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-33
skip back "n" characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-30
space removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-36
special commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
specific data string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-22
specific string
any location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-23
any message ok . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-23
at start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-22
rule belongs to set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-26
turn off rule sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-88, 15-89
zero removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-36
advanced data formatting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3, 15-27
alphanumeric keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-90
alternate rule sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5
bar code menu example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-46
code lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-17

IN-2

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

code types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-11
criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3, 15-11
default rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
numeric keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-24, 15-25
pad spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-37
pad zeros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-41
rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-3
rules hierarchy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-6
send alt characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-65
send control characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46
send function key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-75
send keyboard characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-51
send keypad characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-70
send preset value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-35
setup fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30
skip ahead characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-32
skip back characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-33
space removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-36
special commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
specific data string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-22
turn off rule sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-88, 15-89
zero removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-36
aiming options
decode aiming pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6
aiming pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
enabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6
orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6, 2-7
aiming tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7
ASCII values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .E-3
keyboard wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15
RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12

B
bar codes
123Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-3
beep after good decode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11
beep style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-6
beeper tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6
beeper volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7
bookland EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-12
cancel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4
check for decode LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-12
code 128 emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-56
code 39
transmit buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-28
code 39 full ASCII conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-9
composite CC-A/B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
composite CC-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
composite TLC-39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-52
convert bar codes to code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-8
convert newer code types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-7
Data Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
data options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5
pause duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
prefix/suffix values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-6
transmit code ID character . . . . . . . . . .14-5
decode aiming pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6

decode session timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
digital scanner
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
discrete 2 of 5
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-39
EAN-13/JAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
EAN-8/JAN-8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
flush macro buffer/abort macro PDF entry . 13-63
focus mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
IBM 468X/469X
convert unkown to code 39 . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
port address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
ignore unknown characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10
illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-34
convert to EAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-37
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-35, 13-36
keyboard wedge
alternate numeric keypad emulation . . . 6-9
caps lock on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
capsl ock override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
country keyboard types (country codes) . 6-6
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
host types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
ignore unknown characters . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
intra-keystroke delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
keystroke delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
leading margin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11
Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-57
MicroPDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-55
miscellaneous
scan data options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-7
transmit no read msg . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-9
module width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
numeric bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4
parameter pass-through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
parameter scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
PDF417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-55
postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45
power mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
prefix/suffix values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-6
QR code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-58
RS-232
baud rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
beep on bel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
check receive errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
data bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
hardware handshaking . . . . . . . . .7-14, 7-15
host serial response time-out . . . . . . . . 7-17
host types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
intercharacter delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
parity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
RTS line state . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
software handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16
stop bit select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
samples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
scanner emulation

Index IN-3

beep style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
check for decode LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12
code 39 full ASCII conversion . . . . . . . . 11-9
convert bar codes to code 39 . . . . . . . . 11-8
convert newer code types . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
ignore unknown characters . . . . . . . . 11-10
leading margin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11
module width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
parameter pass-through . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
transmission timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
scanner emulation host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
scanstand session timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
set defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
supplementals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
symbologies
Australian postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-47
buffering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27
codabar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-39
codabar CLSI editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-41
codabar lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-40
codabar NOTIS editing . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-41
code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-31
code 11 lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-32
code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20, 13-21
code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-22
code 39 check digit verification . . . . . 13-25
code 39 full ASCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-26
code 39 lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-24
code 39 transmit check digit . . . . . . . . 13-26
code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-29
code 93 lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-30, 13-31
convert UPC-E to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18
convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . 13-19
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
discrete 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-38
discrete 2 of 5 lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-38
Dutch postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-48
EAN zero extend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-19
I 2 of 5 check digit verification . . . . . . 13-36
I 2 of 5 convert to EAN-13 . . . . . . . . . 13-37
I 2 of 5 transmit check digit . . . . . . . . 13-37
Japan postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-47
MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-42
MSI check digit algorithm . . . . . . . . . . 13-44
MSI check digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-43
MSI lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-42, 13-43
MSI transmit check digit . . . . . . . . . . . 13-44
transmit UK postal check digit . . . . . . 13-46
transmit US postal check digit . . . . . . 13-48
UCC coupon extended code . . . . . . . . 13-20
UCC/EAN-128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-21
UK postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-46
UPC-A preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
UPC-A/E/E1 check digit . . . . . 13-15, 13-16
UPC-E preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17
US planet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45
US postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45

time delay to low power mode . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8
timeout between decodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10
transmission timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-9
trigger mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9
UPC composite mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-53
UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
UPC-E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
UPC-E1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-11
UPC/EAN
coupon code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-20
supp redundancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-14
UPC/EAN/JAN
supplemental redundancy . . . . . . . . . .13-14
USB
caps lock override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
country keyboard types . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4
device type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
keystroke delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
unknown characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
wand emulation
code 39 full ASCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
convert all bar codes to code 39 . . . . . .10-8
default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-4
host types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-5
leading margin (quiet zone) . . . . . . . . . .10-6
polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
unknown characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
beeper
definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
setting tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6
setting volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7

C
cables
installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-4
interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
removing cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-5
signal descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6
character sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .E-3
keyboard wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15
RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12
codabar bar codes
CLSI editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
codabar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-39
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-40
NOTIS editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-41
code 11 bar codes
code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-31
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-32
code 128 bar codes
code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20, 13-21
UCC/EAN-128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21
code 128 emulation bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-56
code 39 bar codes
buffering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-27
check digit verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-25

IN-4

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-22
full ASCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-24
transmit check digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-26
code 93 bar codes
code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-29
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-30, 13-31
code identifiers
AIM code IDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-4
modifier characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
code types
ADF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-11
composite bar codes
composite CC-A/B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
composite CC-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-51
composite TLC-39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-52
UPC composite mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-53
connecting
IBM 468X/469X interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3
interface cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-4
keyboard wedge interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3
power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
RS-232 interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-4
scanner emulation interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-3
synapse cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3
wand emulation interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3

F

D

L

Data Matrix bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-57
decode zones
far focus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
near focus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
toggled focus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11
default parameters
IBM 468X/469X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-4
keyboard wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4
miscellaneous scanner options . . . . . . . . . . .14-4
RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5
scanner emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-4
standard default table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
symbologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-6
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4
user preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4, 5-4
wand emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-4
digital scanner
defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
discrete 2 of 5 bar codes
discrete 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-38

LED definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5

E
exposure options
illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6

focus mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5

H
host types
keyboard wedge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
RS-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
wand emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5

I
IBM 468X/469X
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
intellistand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
interleaved 2 of 5 bar codes
check digit verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-36
convert to EAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-37
transmit check digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-37

K
keyboard wedge
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5

M
macro PDF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-63
flush buffer/abort PDF entry . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-63
maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Maxicode bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-57
MicroPDF417 bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-55
miscellaneous scanner parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-4
mounting
intellistand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
MSI bar codes
check digit algorithm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-44
check digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-43
lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-42, 13-43
MSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-42
transmit check digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-44

N
notational conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii

P
parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
PDF417 bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-55
pinouts
scanner signal descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
postal codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45

Index IN-5

Austalian postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-47
Dutch postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-48
Japan postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-47
transmit UK postal check digit . . . . . . . . . . . 13-46
transmit US postal check digit . . . . . . . . . . . 13-48
UK postal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-46
US planet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45
US postnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-45
power connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
power mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
time delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8

Q
QR code bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-58
quiet zone (leading margin) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6

R
RS-232
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6, 7-8
RSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-49
Convert RSS to UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-50

S
sample bar codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
scanner emulation connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
scanner emulation default parameters . . . . . . . . . 11-4
scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3, 5-3, 13-5, 14-3
hand-held . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
hands-free . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
sequence example . . . . . . . . . 4-3, 5-3, 13-5, 14-3
setup
connecting a USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
connecting an RS-232 interface . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
connecting keyboard wedge interface . . . . . . 6-3
connecting power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
connecting to an IBM 468X/469X host . . . . . . 9-3
connecting using scanner emulation . . . . . . . 11-3
connecting using wand emulation . . . . . . . . . 10-3
installing the cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
signal descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
standard default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
symbology default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
synapse cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6

T
technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
trigger mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3

U
unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4

UPC/EAN bar codes
bookland EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-12
check digit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15, 13-16
convert UPC-E to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-18
convert UPC-E1 to UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-19
EAN zero extend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-19
EAN-13/JAN-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-12
EAN-8/JAN-8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-11
supplementals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-13
UCC coupon extended code . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-20
UPC-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
UPC-A preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-16
UPC-E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
UPC-E preamble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-17
UPC-E1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-11
USB
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4
parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
user preferences parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4, 5-4

W
wand emulation
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3
default parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-4
parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-5

IN-6

DS 3408 Product Reference Guide

Tell Us What You Think...
We’d like to know what you think about this Manual. Please take a moment to fill out this questionnaire and fax this form
to: (631) 738-3318, or mail to:
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza M/S B-4
Holtsville, NY 11742-1300
Attention: Technical Publications Manager
IMPORTANT: If you need product support, please call the appropriate customer support number provided. Unfortunately,
we cannot provide customer support at the fax number above.

Manual Title:___________________________________________
(please include revision level)

How familiar were you with this product before using this manual?
Very familiar
Slightly familiar

Not at all familiar

Did this manual meet your needs? If not, please explain.
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________

What topics need to be added to the index, if applicable?
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________

What topics do you feel need to be better discussed? Please be specific.
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
What can we do to further improve our manuals?
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________________

Thank you for your input—We value your comments.

72-68456-01
Revision A — July 2004



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.5
Linearized                      : Yes
Encryption                      : Standard V2.3 (128-bit)
User Access                     : Print, Copy, Extract, Print high-res
Page Count                      : 396
Page Mode                       : UseOutlines
XMP Toolkit                     : XMP toolkit 2.9.1-13, framework 1.6
About                           : uuid:fe96de26-1d16-4b73-bcef-3fda6ae838b8
Producer                        : Acrobat Distiller 6.0 (Windows)
Create Date                     : 2004:07:13 10:22:15Z
Creator Tool                    : FrameMaker 7.0
Modify Date                     : 2004:07:29 10:11:55-04:00
Metadata Date                   : 2004:07:29 10:11:55-04:00
Document ID                     : uuid:f7fe1f56-20c5-4234-9003-f4a3eae842bb
Format                          : application/pdf
Title                           : untitled
Creator                         : FrameMaker 7.0
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu